Siemens | MC35 | User's Manual | Siemens MC35 User's Manual

AT Command Set
Siemens Cellular Engines
MC35 Module
MC35 Terminal
Version: 04.00
DocID: MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
AT Command Set
Document Name:
AT Command Set
Siemens Cellular Engines
Version:
Date:
Doc Id:
Status:
04.00
02.04.2002
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Released
General note
With respect to any damages arising in connection with the described product or this document,
Siemens shall be liable according to the General Conditions on which the delivery of the described
product and this document are based.
This product is not intended for use in life support appliances, devices or systems where a malfunction
of the product can reasonably be expected to result in personal injury. Siemens AG customers using
or selling this product for use in such applications do so at their own risk and agree to fully indemnify
Siemens for any damages resulting from illegal use or resale.
Applications incorporating the described product must be designed to be in accordance with the technical specifications provided in these guidelines. Failure to comply with any of the required procedures
can result in malfunctions or serious discrepancies in results.
Furthermore, all safety instructions regarding the use of mobile technical systems, including GSM
products, which also apply to cellular phones must be followed.
Handheld applications such as mobile phones or PDAs incorporating the described product must be in
accordance with the guidelines for human exposure to radio frequency energy. The Specific Absorption Rate (SAR) of the application must be evaluated and approved to be compliant with national and
international safety standards or directives.
Subject to change without notice at any time.
Copyright
Copying of this document and giving it to others and the use or communication of the contents thereof,
are forbidden without express authority. Offenders are liable to the payment of damages. All rights reserved in the event of grant of a patent or the registration of a utility model or design.
Copyright © Siemens AG 2002
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 2 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Contents
0
Version History............................................................................................. 8
1
Introduction ................................................................................................ 10
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
1.5.1
1.5.2
1.5.3
Scope of the document .......................................................................................................... 10
Supported product versions and related documents.............................................................. 11
Conventions............................................................................................................................ 12
Supported character sets ....................................................................................................... 12
AT command syntax............................................................................................................... 12
Using parameters ................................................................................................................... 13
Combining AT commands on the same command line.......................................................... 13
Entering successive AT commands on separate lines........................................................... 13
2
Standard V.25ter AT Commands .............................................................. 14
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.7
2.8
2.9
2.10
2.11
2.12
2.13
2.14
2.15
2.16
2.17
2.18
2.19
2.20
2.21
2.22
2.23
2.24
2.25
2.26
2.27
2.28
2.29
2.30
2.31
2.32
2.33
2.34
2.35
2.36
A/ Repeat previous command line ........................................................................................ 14
+++ Switch from data mode or PPP online mode to command mode .................................. 14
AT\Qn Flowcontrol................................................................................................................. 15
ATA Answer a call ................................................................................................................. 15
ATD Mobile originated call to dial a number ......................................................................... 16
ATD><mem><n> Originate call to phone number <n> in memory <mem>.......................... 17
ATD><n> Originate call to phone number selected from active memory ............................. 19
ATD><str> Originate call to phone number in memory with corresponding field.................. 20
ATDI Mobile originated call to dialable ISDN number <n>.................................................... 21
ATDL Redial last telephone number used ............................................................................ 22
ATE Enable command echo.................................................................................................. 23
ATH Disconnect existing connection..................................................................................... 23
ATI Display product identification information ....................................................................... 24
ATI[value] Display additional identification information ......................................................... 24
ATL Set monitor speaker loudness ....................................................................................... 25
ATM Set monitor speaker mode............................................................................................ 25
ATO Switch from command mode to data mode / PPP online mode ................................... 25
ATQ Set result code presentation mode ............................................................................... 26
ATP Select pulse dialling....................................................................................................... 26
ATS0 Set number of rings before automatically answering the call...................................... 26
ATS3 Write command line termination character.................................................................. 27
ATS4 Set response formatting character .............................................................................. 27
ATS5 Write command line editing character ......................................................................... 27
ATS6 Set pause before blind dialling .................................................................................... 28
ATS7 Set number of seconds to wait for connection completion.......................................... 28
ATS8 Set number of seconds to wait for comma dial modifier ............................................. 28
ATS10 Set disconnect delay after indicating the absence of data carrier............................. 29
ATS18 Extended error report ................................................................................................ 29
ATT Select tone dialling......................................................................................................... 29
ATV Set result code format mode ......................................................................................... 30
ATX Set CONNECT result code format and call monitoring ................................................. 30
ATZ Set all current parameters to user defined profile ......................................................... 31
AT&C Set circuit Data Carrier Detect (DCD) function mode ................................................. 31
AT&D Set circuit Data Terminal Ready (DTR) function mode .............................................. 32
AT&F Set all current parameters to manufacturer defaults................................................... 32
AT&S Set circuit Data Set Ready (DSR) function mode ....................................................... 33
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 3 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.37
2.38
2.39
2.40
2.41
2.42
2.43
2.44
2.45
2.45.1
AT&V Display current configuration ...................................................................................... 34
AT&W Store current configuration to user defined profile..................................................... 35
AT+GCAP Request complete TA capabilities list.................................................................. 36
AT+GMI Request manufacturer identification ....................................................................... 36
AT+GMM Request TA model identification ........................................................................... 36
AT+GMR Request TA revision identification of software status ........................................... 37
AT+GSN Request TA serial number identification(IMEI) ...................................................... 37
AT+ILRR Set TE-TA local rate reporting................................................................................ 38
AT+IPR Set fixed local rate .................................................................................................... 39
Autobauding ........................................................................................................................... 40
3
AT Commands for FAX .............................................................................. 41
3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
3.7
3.8
3.9
3.10
3.11
3.12
3.13
3.14
3.15
3.16
3.17
3.18
3.19
3.20
3.21
3.22
3.23
3.24
3.25
3.26
3.27
AT+FBADLIN Bad Line Treshold .......................................................................................... 41
AT+FBADMUL Error Threshold Multiplier ............................................................................. 42
AT+FBOR Query data bit order............................................................................................. 42
AT+FCIG Query or set the Local polling id ........................................................................... 43
AT+FCLASS Fax: Select, read or test service class............................................................. 43
AT+FCQ Copy Quality Checking........................................................................................... 44
AT+FCR Capability to receive ............................................................................................... 44
AT+FDCC Query or set capabilities ...................................................................................... 45
AT+FDFFC Data Compression Format Conversion ............................................................. 46
AT+FDIS Query or set session parameters .......................................................................... 47
AT+FDR Begin or continue phase C data reception ............................................................. 48
AT+FDT Data Transmission.................................................................................................. 48
AT+FET End a page or document ........................................................................................ 49
AT+FK Kill operation, orderly FAX abort ............................................................................... 49
AT+FLID Query or set the Local Id setting capabilities ......................................................... 49
AT+FMDL identify Product Model ......................................................................................... 50
AT+FMFR Request Manufacturer Identification.................................................................... 50
AT+FOPT Set bit order independently .................................................................................. 50
AT+FPHCTO DTE Phase C Response Timeout................................................................... 51
AT+FREV Identify Product Revision ..................................................................................... 51
AT+FRH Receive Data Using HDLC Framing ...................................................................... 51
AT+FRM Receive Data ......................................................................................................... 52
AT+FRS Receive Silence...................................................................................................... 52
AT+FTH Transmit Data Using HDLC Framing...................................................................... 52
AT+FTM Transmit Data......................................................................................................... 53
AT+FTS Stop Transmission and Wait................................................................................... 53
AT+FVRFC Vertical resolution format conversion ................................................................ 54
4
AT Commands originating from GSM 07.07 ............................................ 55
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
4.6.1
4.7
4.8
4.9
4.10
4.11
4.12
4.13
AT+CACM Accumulated call meter (ACM) reset or query.................................................... 55
AT+CALA Set alarm time ...................................................................................................... 56
AT+CAMM Accumulated call meter maximum (ACMmax) set or query ............................... 59
AT+CAOC Advice of Charge information.............................................................................. 60
AT+CBST Select bearer service type ................................................................................... 61
AT+CCFC Call forwarding number and conditions control ................................................... 62
Examples: Call forwarding...................................................................................................... 63
AT+CCLK Real Time Clock................................................................................................... 65
AT+CCUG: Closed User Group ............................................................................................. 66
AT+CCWA Call waiting ......................................................................................................... 67
AT+CEER Extended error report........................................................................................... 68
AT+CFUN Set phone functionality ........................................................................................ 69
AT+CGMI Request manufacturer identification...................................................................... 73
AT+CGMM Request model identification .............................................................................. 73
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 4 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.14
4.15
4.16
4.17
4.18
4.19
4.20
4.21
4.21.1
4.21.2
4.21.3
4.22
4.23
4.24
4.25
4.26
4.27
4.28
4.28.1
4.29
4.30
4.31
4.32
4.33
4.34
4.35
4.35.1
4.36
4.37
4.38
4.39
4.40
4.41
4.42
4.43
4.44
4.45
4.46
4.47
4.48
4.49
4.50
4.51
AT+CGMR Request revision identification of software status .............................................. 73
AT+CGSN Request product serial number identification (IMEI) identical to GSN................ 74
AT+CHLD Call hold and multiparty ........................................................................................ 74
AT+CHUP Hang up call......................................................................................................... 75
AT+CIMI Request international mobile subscriber identity ................................................... 75
AT+CIND Indicator control ..................................................................................................... 76
AT+CLCC List current calls of ME......................................................................................... 78
AT+CLCK Facility lock........................................................................................................... 79
Examples: Enabling / disabling PIN 1 authentication............................................................. 81
Examples: Phone lock ............................................................................................................ 81
Examples: Call barring ........................................................................................................... 83
AT+CLIP Calling line identification presentation ................................................................... 85
AT+CLIR Calling line identification restriction (by *# sequence)........................................... 86
AT+CLVL Loudspeaker volume level.................................................................................... 87
AT+CMER Mobile equipment event reporting....................................................................... 88
AT+CMEE Report mobile equipment error ........................................................................... 89
AT+CMUT Mute control......................................................................................................... 90
AT+CMUX Enter multiplex mode .......................................................................................... 91
Restricted use of AT commands in Multiplex mode ............................................................... 92
AT+COPN Read operator names ......................................................................................... 94
AT+COPS Operator selection ............................................................................................... 95
AT+CPAS Mobile equipment activity status.......................................................................... 97
AT+CPBR Read current phonebook entries ......................................................................... 98
AT+CPBS Select phonebook memory storage ..................................................................... 99
AT+CPBW Write phonebook entry...................................................................................... 100
AT+CPIN Enter PIN............................................................................................................. 101
What to do if PIN or password authentication fails?............................................................. 104
AT+CPIN2 Enter PIN2......................................................................................................... 106
AT+CPUC Price per unit and currency table....................................................................... 108
AT+CPWD Change password............................................................................................. 109
AT+CR Service reporting control......................................................................................... 112
AT+CRC Set Cellular Result Codes for incoming call indication ........................................ 113
AT+CREG Network registration .......................................................................................... 114
AT+CRLP Select radio link protocol param. for orig. non-transparent data call ................. 116
AT+CRSM Restricted SIM access ...................................................................................... 117
AT+CSCS Set TE character set .......................................................................................... 118
AT+CSNS Single Numbering Scheme................................................................................ 119
AT+CSQ Signal quality........................................................................................................ 120
AT+CSSN Supplementary service notifications .................................................................. 121
AT+CUSD Unstructured supplementary service data......................................................... 122
AT+VTD=<n> Tone duration ............................................................................................... 123
AT+VTS DTMF and tone generation (<Tone> in {0-9, *, #, A, B, C, D})............................. 124
AT+WS46 Select wireless network ...................................................................................... 125
5
AT commands originating from GSM 07.05 for SMS ............................ 126
5.1
5.2
5.3
5.4
5.5
5.6
5.7
5.8
5.9
5.10
5.11
5.12
AT+CMGC Send an SMS command................................................................................... 126
AT+CMGD Delete SMS message....................................................................................... 127
AT+CMGF Select SMS message format ............................................................................ 127
AT+CMGL List SMS messages from preferred store ......................................................... 128
AT+CMGR Read SMS message......................................................................................... 131
AT+CMGS Send SMS message ......................................................................................... 134
AT+CMGW Write SMS message to memory ...................................................................... 136
AT+CMSS Send SMS message from storage .................................................................... 138
AT+CNMA New SMS message acknowledge to ME/TE, only phase 2+............................ 139
AT+CNMI New SMS message indications.......................................................................... 140
AT+CPMS Preferred SMS message storage...................................................................... 142
AT+CSCA SMS service centre address.............................................................................. 144
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 5 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.13
5.14
5.15
5.16
AT+CSCB
AT+CSDH
AT+CSMP
AT+CSMS
Select cell broadcast messages ........................................................................ 145
Show SMS text mode parameters..................................................................... 146
Set SMS text mode parameters ........................................................................ 147
Select Message Service.................................................................................... 148
6
GPRS AT commands in accordance with GSM 07.07 ........................... 149
6.1
6.1.1
6.1.2
6.1.3
6.1.4
6.1.5
6.1.6
6.1.7
6.1.8
6.2
6.3
6.3.1
6.3.2
6.4
6.4.1
6.5
Commands specific to MTs supporting GPRS..................................................................... 149
AT+CGATT GPRS attach and detach................................................................................. 149
AT+CGACT PDP context activate or deactivate ................................................................. 150
AT+CGDATA Enter data state ............................................................................................ 151
AT+CGDCONT Define PDP Context .................................................................................. 152
AT+CGQMIN Quality of Service Profile (Minimum acceptable).......................................... 154
AT+CGQREQ Quality of Service Profile (Requested) ........................................................ 158
AT+CGSMS Select service for MO SMS messages........................................................... 162
AT^SGAUTH Set type of authentication for PPP connection ............................................ 163
Modem compatibility commands to MTs supporting GPRS................................................. 164
ATD *99# Request GPRS service....................................................................................... 164
ATD *98# Request GPRS IP service ................................................................................. 165
ATH Manual rejection of a network request for PDP context activation ............................. 166
Using GPRS AT commands (examples) .............................................................................. 167
Miscellaneous AT commands .............................................................................................. 167
Using the GPRS dial command ATD ................................................................................... 169
7
AT Commands for SIM Application Toolkit (GSM 11.14) ...................... 170
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
AT^SSTA Remote-SAT Interface Activation ........................................................................ 171
^SSTN Remote-SAT Notification.......................................................................................... 172
AT^SSTGI Remote-SAT Get Information............................................................................. 173
AT^SSTR Remote-SAT Response....................................................................................... 174
8
Siemens defined AT commands for enhanced functions..................... 175
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.4
8.5
8.6
8.7
8.8
8.9
8.10
8.11
8.12
8.13
8.14
8.15
8.16
8.17
8.18
8.19
8.20
8.21
8.22
8.23
AT+CXXCID Display card ID (identical to AT^SCID) .......................................................... 175
AT^MONI Monitor idle mode and dedicated mode ............................................................. 176
AT^MONP Monitor neighbour cells ..................................................................................... 178
AT^SACM Advice of charge and query of ACM and ACMmax........................................... 179
AT^SBC Battery charging / discharging and charge control ............................................... 180
AT^SCID Display SIM card identification number ............................................................... 183
AT^SCKS Set SIM connection presentation mode and query SIM connection status ....... 184
AT^SCNI List Call Number Information............................................................................... 185
AT^SCTM Set critical operating temperature presentation mode or query temperature .... 186
AT^SDLD Delete the “last number redial“ memory............................................................. 188
AT^SHOM Display Homezone ............................................................................................ 188
AT^SLCD Display Last Call Duration .................................................................................. 188
AT^SLCK Facility lock ......................................................................................................... 189
AT^SMGL List SMS messages from preferred storage ...................................................... 190
AT^SMGO Set or query SMS overflow presentation mode or query SMS overflow........... 191
AT^SMSO Switch off mobile station.................................................................................... 192
AT^SMGR Read SMS message without set to REC READ ............................................... 192
AT^SM20 Set M20 Compatibility......................................................................................... 193
AT^SNFA Set or query microphone attenuation ................................................................. 194
AT^SNFD Set audio parameters to manufacturer default values ....................................... 195
AT^SNFI Set microphone path parameters ........................................................................ 196
AT^SNFM Mute microphone ............................................................................................... 197
Audio programming model ................................................................................................... 197
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 6 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.24
8.25
8.26
8.27
8.28
8.29
8.30
8.31
8.32
8.33
8.34
8.35
8.36
8.37
8.38
AT^SNFO Set audio output (= loudspeaker path) parameter ............................................. 198
AT^SNFS Select audio hardware set.................................................................................. 199
AT^SNFV Set loudspeaker volume..................................................................................... 200
AT^SNFW Write audio setting in non-volatile store ............................................................ 200
AT^SPBC Search the first entry in the sorted telephone book ........................................... 201
AT^SPBG Read entry from active telephone book via sorted index................................... 202
AT^SPBS Steps the selected phonebook alphabetically .................................................... 203
AT^SPIC Display PIN counter ............................................................................................. 204
AT^SPLM Read the PLMN list ............................................................................................ 205
AT^SPLR Read entry from the preferred operators list ...................................................... 206
AT^SPLW Write an entry to the preferred operators list ..................................................... 207
AT^SPWD Change password for a lock.............................................................................. 208
AT^SSDA Set Display Availability ...................................................................................... 210
AT^SSYNC Configure SYNC Pin ........................................................................................ 211
AT^STCD Display Total Call Duration................................................................................. 213
9
APPENDIX................................................................................................. 214
9.1
9.1.1
9.1.2
9.1.3
9.1.4
9.1.5
9.1.6
9.1.7
9.1.8
9.1.9
9.1.10
9.1.11
9.1.12
9.1.13
9.1.14
9.1.15
9.1.16
9.1.17
9.1.18
9.1.19
9.2
9.3
9.4
9.4.1
9.5
Summary of ERRORS and Messages ................................................................................. 214
Summary of CME ERRORS related to GSM 07.07 ............................................................. 214
Summary of GPRS-related CME ERRORS ......................................................................... 215
Summary of CMS ERRORS related to GSM 07.05 ............................................................. 216
Summary of Unsolicited Result Codes (URC) ..................................................................... 218
Result codes......................................................................................................................... 220
Cause Location ID for the extended error report (AT+CEER) ............................................. 220
GSM release cause for L3 Radio Resource (RR) (AT+CEER)........................................... 221
SIEMENS release cause for L3 Radio Resource (RR) (AT+CEER)................................... 221
GSM release cause for L3 Mobility Management (MM) (AT+CEER)................................... 222
SIEMENS release cause for L3 Mobility Management (MM) (AT+CEER)........................... 223
GSM release cause for L3 Call Control (CC) (AT+CEER) ................................................... 223
SIEMENS release cause for L3 Call Control (CC) (AT+CEER)........................................... 224
SIEMENS release cause for L3 Advice of Charge (AOC) (AT+CEER) .............................. 225
GSM release cause for Supplementary Service call (AT+CEER)........................................ 225
Siemens release cause for Call related Supplementary Services (CRSS) (AT+CEER).... 226
GSM release cause for Session Management (SM) (AT+CEER)........................................ 226
SIEMENS release cause for Session Management (SM) (AT+CEER)................................ 227
SIEMENS release cause for GPRS API (AT+CEER) ......................................................... 227
SIEMENS release cause for Embedded Netcore (AT+CEER) .......................................... 228
Summary of PIN requiring AT Commands ........................................................................... 229
AT commands available before entering the SIM PIN ......................................................... 231
Standard GSM service codes............................................................................................... 233
Additional notes on ^SCCFC, ^SCCWA, ^SCLCK............................................................... 235
Alphabet tables..................................................................................................................... 237
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 7 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
0 Version History
This chapter reports modifications and improvements over previous versions of the document.
"AT Command Set" Version MC35-ATC_01_V03.02 => MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Chapter
Page
AT command
What is new
2.2
2.5
2.17
4.8
4.9
4.19
4.21
14
16
25
66
67
76
79
+++
ATD
Chapter revised.
Parameters “G” and “g” for Closed User Group added.
ATO
AT+CCUG
AT+CCWA
AT+CIND
AT+CLCK
4.25
8.2
8.3
8.19
88
176f
178
194
AT+CMER
AT^MONI
At^MONP
AT^SNFA
Chapter revised.
New AT command: Closed User Group.
New AT command: Call Waiting.
New AT command: Indicator control.
Under parameter “PS” lock, the following statement
has been removed: “ME may remember numbers of
previously used cards.”
New AT command: Mobile equipment event reporting.
Statement regarding RING line revised.
8.36
9.1.4
9.2 - 9.3
New AT command: Set or query microphone attenuation
210
AT^SSDA
New AT command: Set Display Availability
218
+CIEV: <text> added to list of URCs
229f - 231f AT+CCUG,
Added to Chapter 9.2 (PIN 1 required).
AT+CCWA,
AT+CMER,
AT^SSDA
AT+CIND
AT^SNFA
Added to Chapter 9.3 (PIN1 independent)
"AT Command Set" Version MC35-ATC_01_V02.00 => MC35_ATC_01_V03.02
Chapter
Page
AT command
1.5.2
4.5
13
61
4.6
4.11
4.21
4.35.1
4.46
62
69
79
104
120
5.11
142
6.1.8
163
Note regarding sequential order of concatenated commands added.
AT+CBST
Command syntax corrected: Parameter <speed> is
mandatory.
AT+CCFC
New <class> parameters added.
AT+CFUN
SLEEP mode described in greater detail
AT+CLCK
New <class> parameters added.
AT+CPIN
Timing algorithm of incorrect password corrected
AT+CSQ
Note added: Realistic BER values can be obtained
only if there is a call in progress.
AT+CPMS
Difference between SM, ME and MT storage explained.
AT^SGAUTH
New command to specify protocol for PPP authentication
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
What is new
Page 8 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.2
176f
AT^MONI
8.7
8.9
184
186
AT^SCKS
AT^SCTM
9.2 - 9.3
229f - 231f AT+CXXCID
AT^SCID
AT^SGAUTH
Channel numbers are now issued in the form of 4-digit
numbers. Therefore, the examples on page 176 have
been updated.
Frequency hopping will now be indicated with “h” (instead of the previously used “0”.
Notes modified: If during a connection the radio cell is
changed, the parameters LAC, Cell, NCC BCC, PWR
and RXLev of the ‘Serving Cell’ part will not be updated.
Notes regarding empty SIM card tray modified.
Chapter revised due to improved presentation of temperature shutdown URCs.
Both commands now independent of PIN authentication
Command added to list of PIN independent commands
9.1 - 9.1.19
9.1.12
214 - 228f
224
Lists of result codes restructured.
Notification number 300 added: “Called party barred incoming call”
9.4
9.4.1
233f
235f
*# codes
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Chapter revised. Further examples added.
Page 9 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
1 Introduction
1.1
Scope of the document
This document presents the AT Command Set for the Siemens cellular engines
MC35 Module
MC35 Terminal
The AT commands detailed in this document are supported by both products. Where differences occur, they are noted in the chapter that refers to the command. In the present version, the only exceptions concern these commands:
Table 1: Product specific use of AT commands
AT command
AT+CALA, Chapter 4.2
MC35 Module
Alarm mode and reminder call
fully applicable
MC35 Terminal
Does not support Alarm mode.
Please ignore any information relating to the subject.
The reminder call can be used as
described.
AT^SSYNC, Chapter 8.37
SYNC pin may be assigned different functions: <mode> 0 or 1.
SYNC pin supports only <mode>=1
(LED status).
AT^SBC, Chapter 8.5
All functions fully applicable
Command not applicable.
MC35 and MC35 Terminal feature basic SIM Application Toolkit (SAT) functionality which enables SIM
cards to run additional network based applications, such as value added services, online banking, information services etc. To give you an idea, Chapter 7 provides a brief overview. In greater detail, the
SAT functions and the required AT commands are described in [4].
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 10 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
1.2
Supported product versions and related documents
Please note that this AT Command Set is intended for MC35 Version 04.00
Related documents
[1] MC35 Hardware Interface Description, Version 04.00
[2] Release Notes: MC35, Version 04.00
[3] MC35 GPRS Startup User's Guide
[4] MC35 Remote-SAT User's Guide, as of Version 04.00
[5] MC35 Multiplexer User's Guide, Version 04.00
[6] Application Note 16: Updating MC35 Firmware, Version 02.00
[7] MC35 Terminal Hardware Interface Description
[8] TC35 MC35 Terminal User's Guide
[9] Application Note 02: Audio Interface
[10] Multiplex Driver Developer’s Guide for Windows 2000 and Windows XP
[11] Multiplex Driver Installation Guide for Windows 2000 and Windows XP
Prior to using MC35 / MC35T or upgrading to a new firmware release, be sure to carefully read and
understand the latest product information provided in the Release Notes.
To visit the Siemens Website you can use the following link:
http://www.siemens.com/wm
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 11 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
1.3
Conventions
Throughout the document, the GSM engines are referred to as ME (Mobile Equipment), MS (Mobile
Station), TA (Terminal Adapter), DCE (Data Communication Equipment) or facsimile DCE (FAX modem, FAX board). When the Siemens product names are required to distinguish the two models,
MC35 is short for the engine type and MC35T for the terminal.
To control your GSM engine you can simply send AT Commands via its serial interface. The controlling device at the other end of the serial line is referred to as TE (Terminal Equipment), DTE (Data
Terminal Equipment) or plainly ´the application´ (probably running on an embedded system).
1.4
Supported character sets
The ME uses 2 character sets: GSM 03.38 (7 bit, see character tables in Chapter 9.5, pg. 234) and
UCS2 (16 Bit, refer ISO/IEC 10646). Also refer to Chapter 4.44 for information about selecting the
character set.
When using an ASCII terminal to write characters differently coded in ASCII and GSM (e.g. Ä, Ö, Ü),
you need to enter escape sequences. Such a character is translated into the corresponding GSM
character value and when output later, the GSM character value is presented. Any ASCII terminal then
will show wrong responses.
Table 2: Character definitions depending on alphabet (examples)
GSM 03.38
character
Ö
"
ò
@
GSM character
hex. value
5C
22
08
1)
00
Corresponding
ASCII character
\
“
BSP
NULL
ASCII
Esc sequence
\5C
\22
\08
\00
Hex
Esc sequence
5C 35 43
5C 32 32
5C 30 38
5C 30 30
1)
Use of the GSM Null character may cause problems on application level when using a ´C´-function
as “strlen()“ and should thus be represented by an escape sequence.
1.5
AT command syntax
The "AT" or "at" prefix must be set at the beginning of each command line. To terminate a command
line enter <CR>.
Commands are usually followed by a response that includes “<CR><LF><response><CR><LF>”.
Throughout this document, only the responses are presented, <CR><LF> are omitted intentionally.
Table 3: Types of AT commands and responses
Test command
AT+CXXX=?
Read command
AT+CXXX?
Write command
Execution command
AT+CXXX=<...>
AT+CXXX
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
The mobile equipment returns the list of parameters and
value ranges set with the corresponding Write command
or by internal processes.
This command returns the currently set value of the parameter or parameters
This command sets user-definable parameter values.
The execution command reads non-variable parameters
affected by internal processes in the GSM engine.
Page 12 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
1.5.1 Using parameters
• Default parameters are underlined throughout this document.
• Optional parameters are enclosed in square brackets. If optional parameters are omitted, the current settings are used until you change them.
• Optional parameters or subparamters can be omitted unless they are followed by other parameters. If you want to omit a parameter in the middle of a string it must be replaced by a comma. Example:
AT+CPBW=,<number>,<type>,<text> writes a phonebook entry to the first free memory location.
AT+CPBW=<index>,<number>,<type>,<text> writes a phonebook entry to the memory location
specified by <index>.
• When the parameter is a character string, e.g. <text> or <number>, the string must be enclosed in
quotation marks, e.g. "Charlie Brown" or "+49030xxxx". Symbols within quotation marks will be
recognized as strings.
• All spaces will be ignored when using strings without quotaton marks.
• It is possible to omit the leading zeros of strings which represent numbers.
• In case of using V.25ter commands without giving an optional parameter, its value is assumed to
be 0.
1.5.2 Combining AT commands on the same command line
You may enter several AT commands on the same line. This eliminates the need to type the "AT" or
"at" prefix before each command. Instead, it is only needed once at the beginning of the command
line. Use a semicolon as command delimiter.
The command line buffer accepts a maximum of 391 characters. If this number is exceeded none of
the commands will be executed and TA returns ERROR.
The table below lists the AT commands you cannot enter together with other commands on the same
line. Otherwise, the responses may not be in the expected order.
Table 4: Illegal combinations of AT commands
V.25ter commands
GSM 7.07 commands
GSM 7.05 commands (SMS)
Commands starting with AT&
AT+IPR
With
With
-------
FAX commands, Prefix AT+F
Siemens commands, Prefix AT^S
To be used standalone
To be used standalone
To be used standalone
Note: When concatenating AT commands please keep in mind that the sequence of processing may
be different from the sequential order of command input. Therefore, if the consecutive order of
the issued commands is your concern, avoid concatenating commands on the same line.
1.5.3 Entering successive AT commands on separate lines
When you enter a series of AT commands on separate lines, leave a pause between the preceding
and the following command until OK appears. This avoids sending too many AT commands at a time
without waiting for a response for each.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 13 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2 Standard V.25ter AT Commands
These AT Commands are related to ITU-T (International Telecommunication Union, Telecommunication sector) V.25ter document.
MC35 supports the registers S0-S29. You can change S0,S3,S4,S5,S6,S7,S8,S10,S18 by using the
appropriate ATSn commands. All the other registers are read-only and for internal usage only!
2.1
A/ Repeat previous command line
Execute command
Response
A/
Repeats previous command line. Line does not need to end with terminating
character.
Parameter
Reference
Note
V.25ter
• After beginning with the character “a“ or „A“, a second character “t“ ,”T“ or “/“
has to follow. In case of using a wrong second character, it is necessary to
start again with character “a“ or “A“.
• If autobauding is active (see +IPR, pg. 38) A/ (and a/) cannot be used.
2.2
+++ Switch from data mode or PPP online mode to command mode
Execute command
Response
+++
This command is only available during a CSD call or a GPRS connection. The
+++ character sequence causes the TA to cancel the data flow over the AT interface and switch to command mode. This allows you to enter AT commands
while maintaining the data connection to the remote device or, accordingly, the
GPRS connection.
OK
To prevent the +++ escape sequence from being misinterpreted as data, it must
be preceded and followed by a pause of at least 1000 ms. The +++ characters
must be entered in quick succession, all within 1000 ms.
Reference
Note:
V.25ter
• To return from command mode to data or PPP online mode: Enter ATO as described in Chapter 2.17.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 14 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.3
AT\Qn Flowcontrol
Execute command
Response
AT\Q<n>
OK
Parameter
<n>
0 AT\Q0 disables flow control
1 AT\Q1 XON/XOFF software flow control
2 AT\Q2 only CTS by DCE
3 AT\Q3 RTS/CTS
Reference
Note
Line state refers to RS-232 levels.
2.4
ATA Answer a call
Execute command
ATA
TA causes remote station to go off-hook (e.g. answer call).
Note1:
Any additional commands on the same command line are ignored.
Note2:
This command may be aborted generally by receiving a character during
execution. It can´t be aborted in some connection setup states, such as
handshaking.
Response
Response in case of data call, if successfully connected:
CONNECT<text> TA switches to data mode.
Note: <text> output only if +ATX parameter setting with value > 0.
Response in case of voice call, if successfully connected:
OK
When TA returns to command mode after call release:
OK
Response if no connection:
NO CARRIER
Parameter
Reference
Note
V.25ter
See also AT+ATX and Chapter 9.1.5 for <text>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 15 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.5
ATD Mobile originated call to dial a number
Execute command
ATD[<n>]
[<mgsm][;]
This command can be used to set up outgoing voice, data or fax calls. It also
serves to control supplementary services.
Note:
The command may be aborted generally when receiving an ATH command during
execution. It can´t be aborted in some connection setup states, such as handshaking. Different behaviour between voice and data call. Behaviour depends on
parameter setting of AT^SM20. Voice call setup terminates immediately with OK.
Data call setup terminates when call has been established.
Response
If no dialtone (parameter setting ATX2 or ATX4):
NO DIALTONE
If busy (parameter setting ATX3 or ATX4):
BUSY
If a connection cannot be set up:
NO CARRIER
If successfully connected and non-voice call:
CONNECT<text> TA switches to data state.
Note:
<text> output only if +ATX parameter setting with value > 0.
When TA returns to command mode after call release:
OK
If successfully connected and voice call:
OK
Parameter
<n>
String of dialling digits and optionally V.25ter modifiers (dialling digits):
0-9, * , #, +, A, B, C
V.25ter modifiers: these are ignored: ,(comma), T, P, !, W, @
Emergency call:
<n>
= 112 worldwide number (no SIM needed)
<mgsm> String of GSM modifiers:
I Activates CLIR (disables presentation of own phone number to called
party)
i Deactivates CLIR (enables presentation of own phone number to
called party)
G Activate Closed User Group explicit invocation for this call only.
g Deactivate Closed User Group explicit invocation for this call only.
<;>
Only required to set up voice calls. TA remains in command mode.
Reference
Note
V.25ter/GSM
07.07
•
•
•
•
•
•
Parameter ”l“ and ”i“ only if no *# code is within the dial string.
<mgsm> is not supported for data calls.
<n> is default for last number that can be dialled by ATDL.
See also +ATX and chapter 9.1.5 for <text>.
The *# codes can only be used with voice calls (i.e.if “;” is appended).
If ATD is used with a USSD command (e.g. ATD*100#;) an AT+CUSD=1 is
executed implicitly (see AT+CUSD, pg. 122).
• Parameter ‘G’ or ‘g’ will be ignored if Closed User Group was already activated,
or accordingly, deactivated with AT+CCUG command.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 16 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.6
ATD><mem><n> Originate call to phone number <n> in memory <mem>
This command allows you to dial a phone number from a specific phonebook. To initiate a call, enter
a two letter abbreviation for the phonebook <mem>, followed by the memory location <n> of the desired entry. The location range of each phonebook can be queried by AT+CPBR (see Chapter 4.32).
Execute command
ATD><mem>
<n>[<mgsm>][;]
TA attempts to set up an outgoing call to the specified number.
Note:
This command may be aborted generally by receiving a character during
execution. Abortion is not possible during some states of connection
setup such as handshaking.
Response
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
If no dialtone (parameter setting ATX2 or ATX4):
NO DIALTONE
If busy (parameter setting ATX3 or ATX4):
BUSY
If connection cannot be set up:
NO CARRIER
If successfully connected and non-voice call:
CONNECT<text> TA switches to data state.
Note: <text> output only if +ATX parameter setting with value > 0.
When TA returns to command mode after call release:
OK
If successfully connected and voice call:
OK
Parameter
<mem> phonebook:
"SM” SIM phonebook (storage depending on SIM card)
”FD” SIM fixdialling phonebook (pos. 1-7)
”LD” SIM last-dialling-phonebook (usually the last 10 numbers dialed are stored on the SIM card, no matter whether or not the
calls were successfully set up)
”MC” ME missed (unanswered received) calls list (up to 10 numbers)
”RC” SIM received calls list
”ME” ME Phonebook (up to 50 numbers)
”ON” SIM (or ME) own numbers (MSISDNs) list
Note: <mem> must be included in quotation marks (""), if parameter
<mgsm> is used. If not, quotation marks are optional.
<n>
Integer type memory location in the range of locations available in
the selected memory, i.e. the index number returned by AT+CPBR.
<mgsm>
I
Activates CLIR (disables presentation of own phone number to
called party)
i
Deactivates CLIR (enables presentation of own phone number
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 17 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
to called party)
<;>
Only required to set up voice calls. TA remains in command mode.
Reference
Note
V.25ter/GSM
07.07
•
•
•
•
•
Example
To query the location number of the phonebook entry:
AT+CPBR=1,xx
There is no <mem> for emergency call (“EN”).
Command is not supported for data call!
Parameter <mgsm> only if no *# code is within the dial string.
The *#-codes can only be used with voice calls (i.e.if “;” is appended).
See also ATX and chapter 9.1.5 for <text>.
TA returns the entries available in the active phonebook.
To dial a number from the SIM phonebook, for example the number stored to location 15:
ATD>SM15;
OK
To dial a phone number stored in the last dial memory on the SIM card:
ATD>LD9;
OK
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 18 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.7
ATD><n> Originate call to phone number selected from active memory
This command can be used to dial a phone number selected from the active memory. The active
memory is the phonebook selected with AT+CPBS (see Chapter 4.33). To set up a call simply enter
the memory location of the desired entry. The memory location range of each phonebook can be
queried by AT+CPBR (see Chapter 4.32).
Execute command
ATD><n>[<mgsm>][;]
TA attempts to set up an outgoing call to the stored number.
Note: This command may be aborted generally by receiving a character
during execution. It can´t be aborted in some connection setup states,
such as handshaking.
Response
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
If no dialtone (parameter setting ATX2 or ATX4):
NO DIALTONE
If busy (parameter setting ATX3 or ATX4):
BUSY
If a connection cannot be set up:
NO CARRIER
If successfully connected and non-voice call:
CONNECT<text> TA switches to data state.
Note: <text> output only if +ATX parameter setting with value > 0.
When TA returns to command mode after call release:
OK
If successfully connected and voice call:
OK
Parameter
<n>
integer type memory location should be in the range of locations
available in the memory used, i.e. the index number returned by
AT+CPBR.
<mgsm> I Activates CLIR (disables presentation of own phone number to
called party)
i Deactivates CLIR (enables presentation of own phone number
to called party)
<;>
Reference
Note
V.25ter/GSM 07.07
•
•
•
•
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Only required to set up voice calls. TA remains in command mode.
Parameter <mgsm> only if no *# code is within the dial string.
Command is not supported for data call!
The *# codes can only be used with voice calls (i.e.if “;” is appended).
See also +ATX and chapter 9.1.5 for <text>.
Page 19 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.8
ATD><str> Originate call to phone number in memory with corresponding field
This command searches the active phonebook for a given string <str> and dials the assigned phone
number. The active phonebook is the one set with AT+CPBS.
Execute command
TA attempts to set up an outgoing call to stored number
ATD><str>[mgsm][;] Note: This command may be aborted generally by receiving a character during execution. It can´t be aborted in some connection setup states,
such as handshaking.
Response
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
If no dialtone (parameter setting ATX2 or ATX4):
NO DIALTONE
If busy (parameter setting ATX3 or ATX4):
BUSY
If a connection cannot be set up:
NO CARRIER
If successfully connected and non-voice call:
CONNECT<text> TA switches to data state.
Note: <text> output only if +ATX parameter setting with value > 0.
When TA returns to command mode after call release:
OK
If successfully connected and voice call:
OK
Parameter
string type value (“x”), which should equal an alphanumeric field in
at least one phonebook entry in the searched memories; used character set should be the one selected with Select TE Character Set
+CSCS. <str> can contain escape sequences as described in
chapter “Supported character sets“, pg. 12.
<str> must be wrapped in quotation marks (""), if escape sequences
or parameter <mgsm> are used or if the alphanumeric strings contains a blank. If not, quotation marks are optional.
<mgsm> I Activates CLIR (disables presentation of own phone number to
called party)
i Deactivates CLIR (enables presentation of own phone number to
called party)
<;>
Only required to set up voice calls. TA remains in command mode.
<str>
Reference
Note
V.25ter/GSM 07.07
Command is not supported for data calls! See also ATX and Chapter 9.1.5 for
<text>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 20 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.9
ATDI Mobile originated call to dialable ISDN number <n>
Execute command
ATDI<n>[;]
TA attempts to set up an outgoing call to ISDN number.
Note:
This command may be aborted generally by receiving a character during
execution. This command cannot be aborted in some connection setup
states, such as handshaking.
Response
If no dialtone (parameter setting ATX2 or ATX4):
NO DIALTONE
If busy (parameter setting ATX3 or ATX4):
BUSY
If a connection cannot be set up:
NO CARRIER
If successful connected and non-voice call:
CONNECT<text> TA switches to data state.
Note: <text> output only if +ATX parameter setting with value > 0.
When TA returns to command mode after call release:
OK
If successfully connected and voice call:
OK
Parameter
<n>
[+]<d>
phone number
string with maximum length of 20 characters
+
international dialling format
<d>
ISDN number
string of digits: +,0-9, A, B, C
<;>
voice call
Reference
V.25ter
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 21 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.10 ATDL Redial last telephone number used
Execute command
ATDL[;]
This command redials the last voice and data call number used in the ATD command.
• To redial the last data call number simply enter ATDL
• To redial the last voice call number type ATDL;
Note:
The command may be aborted generally by receiving a character during
execution. This command cannot be aborted in some connection setup
states, such as handshaking.
Response
If there is no last number or number is not valid:
+CME ERROR
If no dialtone (parameter setting ATX2 or ATX4):
NO DIALTONE
If busy (parameter setting ATX3 or ATX4):
BUSY
If a connection cannot be set up:
NO CARRIER
If successfully connected and non-voice call:
CONNECT<text> TA switches to data state.
Note: <text> output only if +ATX parameter setting with value > 0.
When TA returns to command mode after call release:
OK
If successfully connected and voice call:
OK
Parameter
<;>
voice call
Reference
Note
V.25ter
In case of voice calls “;” is necessary.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 22 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.11 ATE Enable command echo
Write command
ATE[<value>]
This setting determines whether or not the TA echoes characters received from
TE during command state.
Response
OK
Parameter
<value> 0 Echo mode off
1 Echo mode on
Reference
Note
V.25ter
In case of using the command without parameter, <value> is set to 0.
2.12 ATH Disconnect existing connection
Execute command
ATH[n]
Disconnects any call in progress, such as voice calls, CSD data calls and active
GPRS connections. Cancels an active PDP context.
Response
OK
Note:
OK is issued after circuit 109 (DCD) is turned off (RS-232 level), if it was previously on.
Parameter
<n>
0 terminate call
Reference
Note
V.25ter
Using ATH in Multiplex mode (AT+CMUX)
• ATH terminates every data call, even if it is issued via logical channels 2 or 3.
• This behaviour is in accordance with ITU-T V.25 ter; (07/97, see “6.3.6 Hook
control“: "ATH is terminating any call in progress")
Using ATH while GPRS is active (PDP context is activated or online):
• CAUTION: The execution of ATH cancels an active PDP context. This takes
effect no matter whether ATH was used to end a voice or data (CSD) call, to
manually reject a network requested PDP context activation as described in
Chapter 6.3.2 or to terminate a call on one of the virtual channels in Multiplex
mode.
The context deactivation can be avoided by terminating a current call with
AT+CHLD=1 instead of ATH. See Chapter 4.16 for AT+CHLD.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 23 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.13 ATI Display product identification information
Execute command
Response
ATI
ME issues product information text
SIEMENS
REVISION MC35 xx.yy
xx.yy
OK
Explanation of “Revision“ parameter: Version xx and variant yy of software release.
Reference
Note
V.25ter
2.14 ATI[value] Display additional identification information
Execute command
Response
ATI[value]
<value>=9 delivers the following information. Other values are not supported and
only return OK.
ATI9
Reference
SIEMENS Gipsy Soft Protocolstack V2.550
Note
V.25ter
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 24 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.15 ATL Set monitor speaker loudness
Execute command
Response
ATL[val]
OK
Reference
Note
V.25ter
• The two commands ATL and ATM are implemented only for V.25ter compatibility reasons and have no effect.
• In multiplex mode the command is supported on logical channel 1 only.
2.16 ATM Set monitor speaker mode
Execute command
Response
ATM[val]
OK
Reference
Note
V.25ter
• The two commands ATL and ATM are implemented only for V.25ter compatibility reasons and have no effect.
• In multiplex mode the command is supported on logical channel 1 only.
2.17 ATO Switch from command mode to data mode / PPP online mode
Execute command
Response
ATO[n]
ATO is the corresponding command to the +++ escape sequence described in
Chapter 2.2: When you have established a CSD call or a GPRS connection and
TA is in command mode, ATO causes the TA to resume the data or GPRS connection and takes you back to data mode or PPP online mode.
If connection is not successfully resumed
NO CARRIER
or
TA returns to data or PPP online mode from command mode
CONNECT <text>
Note: <text> output only if +ATX parameter setting with value > 0.
Parameter
<n>
Reference
0 switch from command mode to data or PPP online mode
Note
V.25ter
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 25 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.18 ATQ Set result code presentation mode
Write command
Response
ATQ[<n>]
Specifies whether or not the TA transmits any result code to the TE. Information
text transmitted in response is not affected by this setting.
If <n>=0:
OK
If <n>=1:
(none)
Parameter
<n>
0 DCE transmits result code
1 Result codes are suppressed and not transmitted
Reference
Note
V.25ter
2.19 ATP Select pulse dialling
Execute command
Response
ATP
OK
Reference
Note
V.25ter
No effect for GSM
2.20 ATS0 Set number of rings before automatically answering the call
Read command
Response
ATS0?
<n> OK
Write command
Specifies whether or not the TA will accept an incoming data / fax call without
user intervention. <n> determines the number of rings to wait before the TA will
automatically answer.
ATS0=<n>
Response
OK
Parameter
<n>
000
disables automatic answer mode
001-255 enables automatic answering after specified number of rings
Reference
Note
V.25ter
• Auto-answer mode is only applicable to data or fax calls.
• If <n> is set too high, the calling party may hang up before the call can be
automatically answered.
• The correlation between ATS7 and ATS0 is important.
Example: Call setup may fail if ATS0=20 and ATS7=30.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 26 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.21 ATS3 Write command line termination character
Read command
Response
ATS3?
<n> OK
This parameter setting determines the character recognized by TA to terminate
an incoming command line.
Write command
ATS3=<n>
Response
OK
Parameter
<n>
Reference
000-013-127
command line termination character
Note
V.25ter
2.22 ATS4 Set response formatting character
Read command
Response
ATS4?
<n> OK
Write command
This parameter setting determines the character generated by the TA for result
code and information text.
ATS4=<n>
Response
OK
Parameter
<n>
Reference
000-010-127
response formatting character.
Note
V.25ter
2.23 ATS5 Write command line editing character
Read command
Response
ATS5?
<n> OK
Write command
This parameter setting determines the character recognized by TA as a request
to delete the immediately preceding character from the command line.
ATS5=<n>
Response
OK
Parameter
<n>
Reference
000-008-127
command line editing character
Note
V.25ter
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 27 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.24 ATS6 Set pause before blind dialling
Read command
Response
ATS6?
<n> OK
Write command
No effect for GSM
ATS6=<n>
Response
OK
Parameter
<n>
Reference
000-255 number of seconds to wait before blind dialling.
Note
V.25ter
2.25 ATS7 Set number of seconds to wait for connection completion
Read command
Response
ATS7?
<n> OK
Write command
Specifies the number of seconds the TA will wait for the completion of the call
setup when answering or originating a data call. Also referred to as "no answer
timeout". To put it plainly, this is the time to wait for the carrier signal. If no carrier
signal is received within the specified time, the TA hangs up.
ATS7=<n>
Response
OK
Parameter
<n>0 <n>
000 – 060 no. of seconds to wait for connection completion.
Reference
Note
V.25ter
• Values greater than 60 cause no error, but <n> will be restored to the maximum value of 60.
• If called party has specified a high value for ATS0=<n>, call setup may fail.
• The correlation between ATS7 and ATS0 is important.
Example: Call setup may fail if ATS7=30 and ATS0=20.
• ATS7 is only applicable to data calls.
2.26 ATS8 Set number of seconds to wait for comma dial modifier
Read command
Response
ATS8?
<n> OK
Write command
No effect for GSM
ATS8=<n>
Response
OK
Reference
Note
V.25ter
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 28 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.27 ATS10 Set disconnect delay after indicating the absence of data carrier
Read command
Response
ATS10?
<n> OK
Write command
This parameter setting determines the amount of time, that the TA remains connected in absence of a data carrier. If the data carrier is detected before disconnect, the TA remains connected.
ATS10=<n>
Response
OK
Parameter
<n>
Reference
001-002-254
number of tenths of seconds of delay
Note
V.25ter
2.28 ATS18 Extended error report
Test command
Response
ATS18?
<n> OK
Execute command
TA returns an extended report of the reason for the last call release and location.
ATS18=<n>
<n>
0 – 255, odd numbers set extended error report and even
numbers disable this feature.
Response
+Cause: <location ID>: <reason > OK
Parameter
<location ID>
Location ID as number code (see subclause 9.1.6.
<reason>
Reason for last call release as number code (see subclause
9.1.6).
Reference
Note
Siemens
This command works for data calls only. For voice calls please use AT+CEER.
2.29 ATT Select tone dialling
Execute command
Response
ATT
OK
Reference
Note
V.25ter
No effect for GSM
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 29 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.30 ATV Set result code format mode
Write command
Response
ATV[<value>]
This parameter setting determines the contents of the header and trailer transmitted with result codes and information responses.
When <value> =0
0
When <value> =1
OK
Parameter
<value>
0 Information response: <text><CR><LF>
Short result code format: <numeric code><CR>
1 Information response: <CR><LF><text><CR><LF>
Long result code format: <CR><LF><verbose code><CR><LF>
Reference
Note
V.25ter
In case of using the command without parameter <value> will be set to 0.
Information responses described in chapter 9 (verbose code and numeric code).
2.31 ATX Set CONNECT result code format and call monitoring
Write command
Response
ATX[<value>]
This parameter setting determines whether or not the TA detects the presence of
dial tone and busy signal and whether or not TA transmits particular result codes.
OK
Parameter
<value>
0
CONNECT result code only returned, dial tone and busy detection are both disabled
1
CONNECT<text> result code only returned, dial tone and busy
detection are both disabled
2
CONNECT<text> result code returned, dial tone detection is
enabled, busy detection is disabled
3
CONNECT<text> result code returned, dial tone detection is
disabled, busy detection is enabled
4
CONNECT<text> result code returned, dial tone and busy detection are both enabled
Reference
Note
V.25ter
Related <text> see chapter 9.1.5.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 30 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.32 ATZ Set all current parameters to user defined profile
Execute command
Response
ATZ[<value>]
TA sets all current parameters to the user profile stored with AT&W (see Chapter
2.38 on page 35). If a connection is in progress, it will be terminated. All defined
GPRS contexts which are not activated or not online will be undefined (see
+CGDCONT,+CGQREQ,+CGQMIN commands). The user defined profile is
stored to the non-volatile memory.
Note: If invalid, the user profile will be reset to the factory default profile. Any additional commands on the same command line will be ignored. A delay of 300 ms
is required before next command is sent, otherwise “OK” response may be corrupted.
OK
Parameter
<value> 0 Reset to user profile
Reference
Note
V.25ter
The GSM engines referred to in this manual can be assigned two profiles: the
factory profile (restored with AT&F) and the user profile (stored with AT&W). See
Chapter 2.35 for details on AT&F.
2.33 AT&C Set circuit Data Carrier Detect (DCD) function mode
Write command
Response
AT&C[<value>]
This parameter determines how the state of circuit 109(DCD) relates to the detection of received line signal from the distant end.
OK
Parameter
<value>
0
DCD line is always ON.
1
DCD line is ON in the presence of data carrier only.
Reference
Note
V.25ter
Line state refers to RS-232 levels.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 31 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.34 AT&D Set circuit Data Terminal Ready (DTR) function mode
Write command
Response
AT&D[<value>]
This command is only intended for data calls. The <value> parameter determines
how the TA responds when circuit 108/2 (DTR) is changed from ON to OFF during data mode.
OK
Parameter
<value>
0
TA ignores status on DTR.
1
ON->OFF on DTR: Change to command mode while retaining
the connected call.
2
ON->OFF on DTR: Disconnect data call, change to command
mode. During state DTR = OFF is auto-answer off.
Reference
Note
V.25ter
Line state refers to RS-232 levels.
2.35 AT&F Set all current parameters to manufacturer defaults
Execute command
Response
AT&F[value]
TA sets all current parameters to the manufacturer defined profile.
OK
Parameter
<value>
0
set all TA parameters to manufacturer default
Reference
Note
V.25ter
• List of parameters reset to manufacturer default (sorted by the associated AT
commands):
E, Q, V, X, +CBST, +CRLP, +CRC, +CR, +CNMI, +CMEE, +CSMS, ^SCKS,
^SACM, +CREG, +CLIP, the S Parameters, &D, &C, &S, +CGDCONT,
+CGQREQ, +CGQMIN
• In addition to the default profile, you can store an individual one with AT&W. To
alternate between the two profiles enter either ATZ (loads user profile) or AT&F
(restores factory profile). Refer to Chapter 2.38 for AT&W and Chapter 2.32 for
ATZ.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 32 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.36 AT&S Set circuit Data Set Ready (DSR) function mode
Write command
Response
AT&S<value>
This parameter determines how the TA sets circuit 107 (DSR) depending on the
communication state of the TA interfacing TE.
OK
Parameter
<value>
0
DSR always on.
1
TA in command mode: DSR is OFF.
TA in data mode: DSR is ON.
Reference
Note
V.25ter
Line state refers to RS-232 levels.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 33 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.37 AT&V Display current configuration
Execute command
Response
AT&V[<n>]
TA returns the current parameter setting. The configuration varies depending on
whether or not PIN authentication has been done, or Multiplex mode has been
activated.
Parameter
Configuration
without Multiplex
mode or configuration on channel 1 if Multiplex
mode is enabled
Logical channels
2 and 3 (Multiplex mode enabled)
<n>
0 profile number
PIN entered or not required (see
AT+CPIN, pg. 100)
ACTIVE PROFILE:
E1 Q0 V1 X4 &C1 &D2 &S0 \Q0
S0:000 S3:013 S4:010 S5:008 S6:000 S7:060
S8:000 S10:002 S18:000
+CBST: 7,0,1
+CRLP: 61,61,78,6
+CR: 0
+FCLASS: 0
+CRC: 0
+CMGF: 0
+CNMI: 0,0,0,0,1
+ILRR: 0
+IPR: 0
+CMEE: 0
^SMGO: 0,0
+CSMS: 0,1,1,1
^SACM: 0,"000000","000000"
^SCKS: 0,1
+CREG: 0,1
+CLIP: 0,2
+CAOC: 0
+COPS: 0,0,"operator"
OK
+CRC: 0
+CMGF: 0
+CNMI: 0,0,0,0,1
+ILRR: 0
+IPR: 19200
+CMEE: 0
^SMGO: 0,0
+CSMS: 0,1,1,1
^SACM: 0,"000000","000000"
^SCKS: 0,1
+CREG: 0, 1
+CLIP: 0,2
+CAOC: 0
+COPS: 0,0,"operator"
Required PIN not entered
ACTIVE PROFILE:
E1 Q0 V1 X4 &C1 &D2 &S0 \Q0
S0:000 S3:013 S4:010 S5:008 S6:000 S7:060
S8:000 S10:002 S18:000
+CBST: 7,0,1
+CRLP: 61,61,78,6
+CR: 0
+FCLASS: 0
+ILRR: 0
+IPR: 0
+CMEE: 0
^SCKS: 0,1
OK
+ILRR: 0
+IPR: 19200
+CMEE: 0
^SCKS: 0,1
OK
OK
Reference
Note:
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Parameter values and order are subject to change.
Page 34 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.38 AT&W Store current configuration to user defined profile
Execute command
TA stores the current settings to a user defined profile in the non-volatile memory.
AT&W[<n>]
Response
OK or if error is related to ME functionality: ERROR / +CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<n>
0 number of profile
Reference
Note
V.25ter
The user defined profile will be loaded automatically after PowerUp. Use ATZ to
restore user profile and AT&F to restore factory settings. Until the first use of
AT&W, ATZ works as AT&F. See Chapter 2.32 for details on ATZ and Chapter
2.35 for AT&F.
List of settings stored to user defined profile:
• ATE, ATQ, ATV, ATX, AT+CRC, AT+CMGF, AT+CSDH, AT+CNMI, AT+ILRR,
AT+CMEE, AT^SMGO, AT+CSMS, AT^SACM, ^SCKS, AT+CREG, AT+CLIP,
AT+COPS.
AT&C, AT&D, AT&S, ATS0, ATS3, ATS4, ATS5, ATS6, ATS7, ATS8, ATS10,
ATS18, AT+FCLASS, AT+CBST, AT+CRLP, AT+CR.
User defined profiles in multiplex mode:
• On each multiplexer channel you can save an individual profile.
• List of settings stored to profile on multiplexer channel 1:
ATE, ATQ, ATV, ATX, AT+CRC, AT+CMGF, AT+CSDH, AT+CNMI, AT+ILRR,
AT+CMEE, AT^SMGO, AT+CSMS, AT^SACM, ^SCKS, AT+CREG, AT+CLIP,
AT+COPS.
AT&C, AT&D, AT&S, ATS0, ATS3, ATS4, ATS5, ATS6, ATS7, ATS8, ATS10,
ATS18, AT+FCLASS, AT+CBST, AT+CRLP, AT+CR.
• List of settings stored to profile on multiplexer channels 2 and 3:
ATE, ATQ, ATV, ATX, AT+CRC, AT+CMGF, AT+CSDH, AT+CNMI, AT+ILRR,
AT+CMEE, AT^SMGO, AT+CSMS, AT^SACM, ^SCKS, AT+CREG, AT+CLIP,
AT+COPS. (Parameters for data call are not relevant on channels 2 and 3.)
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 35 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.39 AT+GCAP Request complete TA capabilities list
Test command
Response
AT+GCAP=?
OK
Parameter
Execute command
Response
AT+GCAP
TA reports a list of additional capabilities.
+GCAP: <name>
OK
Parameter
<name> e.g.: +CGSM,+FCLASS
Reference
Note
V.25ter
+CGSM: The response text shows which GSM commands of the ETSI standard
are supported.
2.40 AT+GMI Request manufacturer identification
Test command
Response
AT+GMI=?
OK
Execute command
Response
AT+GMI
TA reports information to identify the manufacturer.
SIEMENS
OK
Reference
Note
V.25ter
See also ”AT+CGMI Request manufacturer identification”.
2.41 AT+GMM Request TA model identification
Test command
Response
AT+GMM=?
OK
Execute command
TA reports one or more lines of information text which permit the user to identify
the specific model of device.
MC35
OK
AT+GMM
Reference
Note
V.25ter
See also ”AT+CGMM Request model identification”.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 36 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.42 AT+GMR Request TA revision identification of software status
Test command
Response
AT+GMR=?
OK
Execute command
Response
AT+GMR
TA returns product software version identification text.
REVISION xx.yy
OK
xx.yy
Version xx and variant yy of software release.
Reference
Note
V.25ter
See also AT+CGMR Request revision identification of software status
2.43 AT+GSN Request TA serial number identification(IMEI)
Test command
Response
AT+GSN=?
OK
Execute command
Response
AT+GSN
TA reports one or more lines of information text which permit the user to identify
the individual device.
<sn>
OK
Parameter
<sn>
IMEI of the telephone(International Mobile station Equipment Identity)
Reference
Note
V.25ter
The serial number (IMEI) varies for every individual ME device.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 37 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.44 AT+ILRR Set TE-TA local rate reporting
Test command
Response
AT+ILRR=?
+ILRR: (list of supported <value>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+ILRR?
+ILRR: <value> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
AT+ILRR=
<value>
The write command specifies whether or not an intermediate result code shall indicate the currently used local rate when an incoming or outgoing data call is established. The message is transmitted from the DCE (= TA) to the DTE (=TE) before the final result code of the connection setup (e.g. CONNECT) appears.
Response
OK
Parameter
<value> 0 Disables reporting of local port rate
1 Enables reporting of local port rate
Intermediate result code
+ILLR:<rate>
Parameter
<rate>
port rate setting in bit per second
0 (Autobauding, see Chapter 2.45.1)
300
600
1200
2400
4800
9600
19200
38400
57600
115200
Reference
Note
V.25ter
Example
ATD030112233445
+ILRR: 57600
CONNECT 9600/RLP
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 38 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
2.45 AT+IPR Set fixed local rate
Test command
Response
AT+IPR=?
+IPR: (list of supported auto-detectable <rate>s), (list of supported fixed-only
<rate>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+IPR?
+IPR: <rate> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
AT+IPR=<rate>
This command specifies the DTE-DCE bitrate. When you set a fix rate, make sure
that both DTE (TE) and DCE (= TA) are configured to the same rate. When you
select autobauding the DCE will automatically recognize the bitrate currently used
by the DTE.
A selected bitrate takes effect following the issue of any result code associated
with this command (e.g. OK).
The setting is stored in the non-volatile memory and will be used whenever the
engine is powered up again. However, in case of autobaud mode (+IPR=0) the
detected DCE bitrate will not be saved and, therefore, needs to be be resynchronized after restarting the GSM engine (see Chapter 2.45.1).
Response
OK or if error is related to ME functionality: ERROR / +CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<rate> bit rate per second
0 (Autobauding, see Chapter 2.45.1)
300
600
1200
2400
4800
9600
14400
19200
28800
38400
57600
115200
Reference
Note
V.25ter
Your current setting of AT+IPR will be preserved
• when you download new firmware (i.e. a firmware update does not restore the
factory setting);
• in the event of power failure.
Generally, AT+IPR=x should be used as a standalone command. If nevertheless
combinations with other commands on the same line cannot be avoided, there are
several constraints to be considered:
• Avoid combinations with the AT commands listed in Chapter 1.5.2.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 39 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
• Take into account that a delay of 100 ms is required between a response to the
last command (e.g. OK) and the next command on the same line.
• When you enter AT+IPR=0, autobauding will be activated after the response to
the last command is received.
• When local echo is active (ATE1) and you enter AT+IPR=x with other commands you may encounter the following problem: If switching to the new bit
rate takes effect while a response is being transmitted, the last bytes may be
sent at the new bit rate and thus, not properly transmitted. The following commands will be correctly sent at the new bit rate.
2.45.1 Autobauding
Autobauding allows the GSM engine to automatically detect the bitrate configured in the host application. The serial interface of the GSM engine supports autobauding for the following bitrates: 1200,
2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200. Factory setting is autobauding enabled. This gives
you the flexibility to put the GSM engine into operation no matter what bitrate your host application is
configured to.
To take advantage of autobaud mode specific attention must be paid to the following requirements:
Synchronization between DTE and DCE
Ensure that DTE and DCE are correctly synchronized and the bitrate used by the DTE is detected by
the DCE (= ME). To allow the bitrate to be synchronized simply issue an "AT" or "at" string. This is
necessary
• after you have activated autobauding
• when you start up the GSM engine while autobauding is enabled. It is recommended to wait 3 to 5
seconds before sending the first AT character. Otherwise undefined characters might be returned.
If you want to use autobauding and autoanswer at the same time, you can easily enable the synchronization, when you activate autobauding first and then configure the autoanswer mode (ATS0=0).
Restrictions on autobauding operation
• The serial interface has to be operated at 8 data bits, no parity and 1 stop bit (factory setting).
• The A/ command (and a/) cannot be used.
• Only the strings “AT“ or “at“ can be detected (neither “aT“ nor “At“).
• The Unsolicited Result Codes "^SYSSTART", "^SYSSTART ALARM MODE" and "^SYSSTART
CHARGE-ONLY MODE" are not indicated when you start up the ME while autobauding is enabled.
This is due to the fact that the new bitrate is not detected unless DTE and DCE are correctly synchronized as described above.
• Any other Unsolicited Result Codes that may be issued before the ME detects the new bitrate (by
receiving the first AT command string) will be sent at the previous bitrate.
• It is not recommended to switch to autobauding from a bitrate that cannot be detected by the autobaud mechnism (e.g. 300 baud). Responses to +IPR=0 and any commands on the same line might
be corrupted.
• When entering several AT commands on the same line, consider the requirements described in the
Notes of Chapter 2.45.
• See also AT+ILRR Set TE-TA local rate reporting , pg. 37
Autobauding and multiplex mode
If autobauding is active you cannot switch to multiplex mode (see +CMUX, pg. 91). Vice versa, when
you run the multiplex mode, the write command AT+IPR=<rate> cannot be used.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 40 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3 AT Commands for FAX
The following commands can be used for FAX transmission.
If the ME is acting as a Fax-Modem to a PC-based application (e.g. “WinFax“) it is necessary to select
the proper Service Class (Fax Class) provided by the ME. The ME reports its Service Class capabilities, both the current setting and the range of services available. This is provided by the AT+FCLASS
command (see pg. 43).
Note: When sending a FAX with a standard FAX application for Personal Computers it is recommended to use autobauding (AT+IPR=0).
ME
+
+
Currently defined Service Class values (see TIA/EIA-592-A)
+FCLASS parameter Service Class
Reference, Standard
e.g. TIA/EIA-602 or ITU V.25ter
0
data modem
1
1.0
2
+
2.0
2.1
8
Reserved
Service Class 1
EIA/TIA-578-A
Service Class 1
manufacture specific
ITU-T T.31
this document and EIA PN-2388 (draft)
Service Class 2
Service Class 2
Voice DCE
TIA/EIA-592
TIA/EIA-592-A or ITU-T T.32
TIA IS-101
Note: Be aware that there is a difference between Service Classes 2 and 2.0! Only the first is applicable to the ME.
3.1
AT+FBADLIN Bad Line Threshold
Read command
AT+FBADLIN?
This command defines the “Copy-Quality-OK”-threshold. If <badline> consecutive lines have pixel count errors in normal resolution (98 dpi) mode, then the
copy quality is unacceptable. If <badline> * 2 consecutive lines have pixel count
errors in fine resolution (196 dpi) mode, then the copy quality is unacceptable.
“Copy Quality Not OK” occurs if either the error percentage is too high or too
many consecutive lines contain errors. A value of 0 implies that error checking
is not present or disabled.
Response
<badlin> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+FBADLIN=
<badlin>
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
ERROR
Parameter
<badlin>
0 – 10 – 255 bad lines
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
Used for Fax class 2 only
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 41 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3.2
AT+FBADMUL Error Threshold Multiplier
Read command
AT+FBADMUL?
This command defines the “Copy-Quality-OK” multiplier. The number of lines
received with a bad pixel count is multiplied by this number. If the result exceeds the total number of lines on the page the error rate is considered too
high. A threshold multiplier value of 20 corresponds to a 5% error rate. A value
of 0 implies that error checking is not present or disabled.
Response
<badmul> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+FBADMUL=
<n>
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
ERROR
Parameter
<n>
0 – 20 – 255
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
Used for Faxclass 2 only
3.3
AT+FBOR Query data bit order
Test command
AT+FBOR=?
Query the bit order for receive-mode. The mode is set by the ME dependent on
the selected Service Class, see “AT+FCLASS Fax: Select, read or test service
class”, pg. 43.
Response
(list of supported bit order modes <bor>s)
OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+FBOR?
<bor> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+FBOR=<bor>
OK
Parameter
<bor>
0
direct bit order for both Phase C and for Phase B/D data.
1
Reversed bit order for Phase C data, direct Bit Order for
Phase B/D data.
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
Used for Fax class 2 only
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 42 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3.4
AT+FCIG Query or set the Local polling id
Test command
Response
AT+FCIG =?
(max. length of Local Polling ID string) (range of supported ASCII character values) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+FCIG?
<id> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+FCIG =<id>
OK
Parameter
<id>
Local Polling ID string, max. length and possible content as reported
by test command. Default value is empty string (“”).
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
See also “AT+FLID Query or set the Local Id setting capabilities”, pg. 49.
Used for Faxclass 2 only
3.5
AT+FCLASS Fax: Select, read or test service class
Test command
See introduction to fax commands, pg. 41.
AT+FCLASS=?
Response
(list of supported <n>s)
OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+FCLASS?
<n> OK
Parameter
Write command
AT+FCLASS=
<n>
See write command
The ME is set to a particular mode of operation (data, fax). This causes the MA
to process information in a manner suitable for that type of information.
Response
OK
Parameter
<n>
0
data (e.g. EIA/TIA-602 or ITU V.25ter)
1
Fax class 1 (EIA/TIA-578-A, Service Class 1)
2
Fax class 2 (EIA/TIA SP-2388, an early draft version of
EIA/TIA-592-A – Service class 2.1)
Reference
Note
EIA/TIA-592-A
Using Error Correcting Mode (ECM) when sending FAXes over GSM should be
avoided.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 43 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3.6
AT+FCQ Copy Quality Checking
Test command
This command controls Copy Quality checking when receiving a fax.
AT+FCQ =?
Response
(list of supported copy quality checking <cq>s)
OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+FCQ?
<cq> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+FCQ =<cq>
OK
Parameter
<cq>
0
No copy quality checking. The ME will generate Copy Quality OK (MCF) responses to complete pages.
1
ME can check 1-D phase data. The connected application
must check copy quality for 2-D phase C data
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
Used for for Faxclass 2 only.
3.7
AT+FCR Capability to receive
Write command
Response
AT+FCR=<cr>
OK
Parameter
<cr>
0
ME will not receive message data. This can be used when
the application has insufficient storage. The ME can send
and can be polled for a file.
1
ME can receive message data.
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
Used for Faxclass 2 only
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 44 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3.8
AT+FDCC Query or set capabilities
Test command
AT+FDCC =?
This command allows the connected application to sense and constrain the
capabilities of the facsimile DCE (=ME), from the choices defined in CCITT
T.30 Table 2.
Response
(list of <VR>s), (list of <BR>s), (list of <WD>s), (list of <LN>s), (list of <DF>s),
(list of <EC>s), (list of <BF>s), (list of <ST>s)
OK
Parameter
VR: Vertical Resolution, BR: Bit Rate, WD: Page Width, LN: Page Length, DF:
Data Compression Format, EC: Error Correction Mode, BF: Binary File
Transfer Mode, ST: Scan Time/Line.
Note: For further information see AT+FDIS, pg. 47
Read command
Response
AT+FDCC?
<dcc> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+FDCC=<VR>,
<BR>,<WD>,<LN>,
<DF>,<EC>,<BF>,
<ST>
OK
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
Used for Faxclass 2 only
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Parameter
VR: Vertical Resolution, BR: Bit Rate, WD: Page Width, LN: Page Length, DF:
Data Compression Format, EC: Error Correction Mode, BF: Binary File
Transfer Mode, ST: Scan Time/Line.
Note: For further information see AT+FDIS, pg. 47
Page 45 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3.9
AT+FDFFC Data Compression Format Conversion
Test command
AT+FDFFC=?
This parameter determines the ME response to a mismatch between the data
format negotiated for the facsimile session, reported by the +FDCS:DF subparameter, and the Phase C data desired by the controlling application, indicated by the optional +FDT:DF subparameter, or the +FDIS=DF subparameter
for the +FDR operation.
Response
(list of supported <df>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+FDFFC?
<df> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+FDFFC =<df>
OK
Parameter
<df>
0
Mismatch checking is always disabled. The controlling application has to check the +FDCS: DF subparameter and
transfer matching data.
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
Used for Fax Class 2 only
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 46 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3.10 AT+FDIS Query or set session parameters
Test command
AT+FDIS =?
This command allows the controlling application to sense and constrain the
capabilities used for the current session. It uses +FDIS to generate DIS or
DTC messages directly, and uses +FDIS and received DIS messages to generate DCS messages.
Response
(list of <VR>s), (list of <BR>s), (list of <WD>s), (list of <LN>s), (list of <DF>s),
(list of <EC>s), (list of <BF>s), (list of <ST>s)
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+FDIS?
<cdec> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+FDIS =
<VR>,<BR>,<WD>,
<LN>,<DF>,<EC>,
<BF>,<ST>
OK
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
Used for Faxclass 2 only
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Parameter
Vertical Resolution
VR
0
normal, 98 lpi
1
fine, 196 lpi
Bit Rate
BR 0
2400 bit/s, V.27ter
1
4800 bit/s, V.27ter
2
7200 bit/s, V.29
3
9600 bit/s, V.29
Page Width
WD 0 *)
1728 pixels in 215mm
1
2048 pixels in 255 mm
2
2432 pixels in 303 mm
3
1216 pixels in 151 mm
4
864 pixels in 107 mm
Page Length
LN
0
A4, 297mm
1
B4, 364mm
2
unlimited length
Data Compression Format DF
0 *)
1-D modified Huffman
1
2-D modified read
2
2-D uncompressed mode
Error correction
EC 0 *)
disable ECM
(Annex A/T.30)
1
enable ECM, 64 bytes/frame
2
enable ECM, 256 bytes/frame
Binary File mode
BF
0 *)
disable BFT
Transfer Mode
1
enable BFT
Scan Time/Line
ST
0 *)
0 ms (at VR= normal)
1
5 ms
2
10 ms
3
10 ms
4
20 ms
5
20 ms
6
40 ms
7
40 ms
*) Note: Only the default value needs to be implemented. Use test command
to check which parameter values are really possible!
Page 47 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3.11 AT+FDR Begin or continue phase C data reception
Execute command
The +FDR command initiates transition to Phase C data reception.
AT+FDR
Response
CONNECT
or
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
ERROR
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
Used for Faxclass 2 only
3.12 AT+FDT Data Transmission
Execute command
AT+FDT
This command requests the ME to transmit a Phase C page. When the ME is
ready to accept Phase C data, it issues the negotiation responses and the
CONNECT result code to the application.
In Phase B, the +FDT command releases the ME to proceed with negotiation,
and releases the DCS message to the remote station. In Phase C, the +FDT
command resumes transmission after the end of a data stream transmited
before.
Response
CONNECT
Write command
Response
AT+FDT =<dt>
CONNECT
Parameter
<dt>
DF,VR,BR,WD,LN comma separated parameter list
Data Compression Format
DF
0
1
2
1-D modified Huffman
2-D modified read
2-D uncompressed mode
Vertical Resolution
VR
Bit Rate
BR
0
1
0
1
2
3
normal, 98 lpi
fine, 196 lpi
2400 bit/s, V.27ter
4800 bit/s, V.27ter
7200 bit/s, V.29
9600 bit/s, V.29
Page Width
WD
Page Length
LN
0
1
2
3
4
0
1
2
1728 pixels in 215mm
2048 pixels in 255 mm
2432 pixels in 303 mm
1216 pixels in 151 mm
864 pixels in 107 mm
A4, 297mm
B4, 364mm
unlimited length
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
Used for Faxclass 2 only
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 48 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3.13 AT+FET End a page or document
Write command
AT+FET=<ppm>
This command indicates that the current page or partial page is complete. An
ERROR response code results if this command is issued while the mode is onhook.
Response
OK
Parameter
<ppm>
Post Page Message Codes
1 another document next
2 no more pages or documents
4 another page, procedure interrupt
5 another document, procedure interrupt
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
Used for Faxclass 2 only
3.14 AT+FK Kill operation, orderly FAX abort
Execute command
This command causes the TA to terminate the session in an orderly manner.
AT+FK
Response
OK
Reference
Note
Used for Faxclass 2 only
3.15 AT+FLID Query or set the Local Id setting capabilities
Test command
Response
AT+FLID =?
(max. character length of Local ID string) (range of supported ASCII character
values) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+FLID?
< lid > OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+FLID =<lid>
OK
Parameter
<lid>
Local ID string, max. length and possible content as reported by test
command. Default value is empty string (“”).
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
See also “AT+FCIG Query or set the Local polling id”, pg. 42.
Used for Faxclass 2 only
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 49 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3.16 AT+FMDL identify Product Model
Read command
Send the model identification to the TA
AT+FMDL?
Response
Gipsy Soft Protocolstack
OK
Reference
Note
Siemens
Used for Faxclass 2 only
3.17 AT+FMFR Request Manufacturer Identification
Read command
Send the manufacturer identification to the TA
AT+FMFR?
Response
SIEMENS
OK
Reference
Note
Siemens
Used for Fax class 2 only
3.18 AT+FOPT Set bit order independently
Write command
AT+FOPT=<opt>
Model specific command to set bit order independently of the understanding
which is "mirrored" and which is direct.
Response
OK
Parameter
<opt>
0 non-standard
1 standard
Reference
Note
Siemens
Used for Fax class 2 only
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 50 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3.19 AT+FPHCTO DTE Phase C Response Timeout
Read command
AT+FPHCTO?
The time-out value <tout> determines how long the DCE will wait for a command
after reaching the end of data when transmitting in Phase C. When time-out is
reached, the DCE assumes that there are no more pages or documents to send.
Response
<tout> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Parameter
AT+FPHCTO=
<tout>
<tout>
0 – 30 – 255
time-out value in 100ms units.
Response
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
ERROR
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
Used for Fax class 2 only
3.20 AT+FREV Identify Product Revision
Test command
Sends the revision identification to the TA
AT+FREV?
Response
V2.550
OK
Reference
Note
Siemens
Used for Fax class 2 only
3.21 AT+FRH Receive Data Using HDLC Framing
Execute command
This command causes the TA to receive frames using the HDLC protocol and the
AT+FRH=<mod> modulation defined below. An ERROR response code results if this command is
issued while the modem is on-hook.
Response
CONNECT
If error is related to ME functionality:
ERROR
Parameter
<mod>
modulation mode
3
V21 Ch2
24
V.27ter
2400 bps
48
V.27ter
4800 bps
72
V.29
7200 bps
96
V.29
9600 bps
Reference
Note
TIA/EIA-578
Used for Fax class 1 only
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
300 bps
Page 51 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3.22 AT+FRM Receive Data
Test command
Response
AT+FRM=?
(List of supported modulation modes <mod>s) OK
Parameter
Write command
AT+FRM=<mod
>
See write command
This command causes the TA to enter the receiver-mode using the modulation
defined below. An ERROR response code results if this command is issued while
the modem is on-hook.
Response
CONNECT
If error is related to ME functionality:
ERROR
Parameter
<mod>
96
V.29
9600 bps
72
V.29
7200 bps
48
V.27ter
4800 bps
24
V.27ter
2400 bps
Reference
Note
TIA/EIA-578
Used for Faxclass 1 only
3.23 AT+FRS Receive Silence
Write command
AT+FRS=<time>
+FRS=n causes the TA to report an OK result code to the TE after <time> 10 millisecond intervals of silence have been detected on the line. This command is
aborted if any character is received by the DTE. The modem discards the aborting character and issues an OK result code. An ERROR response code results if
this command is issued while the mode is on-hook.
Response
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
ERROR
Parameter
<time>
0 – 255 no. of 10 millisecond intervals
Reference
Note
TIA/EIA-578
Used for Faxclass 1 only
3.24 AT+FTH Transmit Data Using HDLC Framing
Write command
AT+FTH=<mod>
This command causes the TA to transmit data using HDLC protocol and the
modulation mode defined below. An ERROR response code results if this command is issued while the modem is on-hook.
Response
CONNECT
Parameter
<mod>
3 V.21 Ch2
300 bps
Reference
Note
TIA/EIA-578
Used for Faxclass 1 only
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 52 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3.25 AT+FTM Transmit Data
Test command
Response
AT+FTM=?
(List of supported modulation modes) OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
This command causes the TA to transmit data using the modulation mode deAT+FTM=<mod> fined below. An ERROR response code results if this command is issued while
the modem is on-hook.
Response
CONNECT
If error is related to ME functionality:
ERROR
Parameter
<mod>
modulation mode
96
V.29
9600 bps
72
V.29
7200 bps
48
V.27ter
4800 bps
24
V.27ter
2400 bps
Reference
Note
TIA/EIA-578
Used for Fax class 1 only
3.26 AT+FTS Stop Transmission and Wait
Write command
AT+FTS=<time>
This command causes the TA to terminate a transmission and wait for <time> 10
millisecond intervals before responding with the OK result code to the DTE.
Response
An ERROR response code results if this command is issued while the modem is
on-hook.
Parameter
<time>
0 – 85
no. of 10 millisecond intervals
Reference
Note
TIA/EIA-578
Used for Fax class 1 only
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 53 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
3.27 AT+FVRFC Vertical resolution format conversion
Test command
AT+FVRFC =?
This command determines the DCE response to a mismatch between the vertical
resolution negotiated for the facsimile session and the Phase C data desired by
the DTE.
Response
(List of supported mismatch checking modes) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+FVRFC?
<vrfc> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+FVRFC
=<vrfc>
OK
Parameter
<vrfc>
0
disable mismatch checking.
2
enable mismatch checking, with resolution conversion of 1-D
data in the DCE, and an implied AT+FK command executed
on 2-D mismatch detection
Reference
Note
EIA PN-2388
Used for Fax class 2 only
The following AT commands are dummy commands. Invoking these commands will not cause ERROR result codes, but these commands have no functionality.
AT+FAA
AT+FECM
AT+FLNFC
AT+FLPL
AT+FMINSP
AT+FRBC
AT+FREL
AT+FSPL
AT+FTBC
AT+FWDFC
Auto Answer mode
Error Correction Mode control
Page Length format conversion
Indicate document available for polling
Minimum Phase C speed
Phase C data receive byte count
Phase C received EOL alignment
Enable polling
Phase C data transmit byte count
Page width format conversion
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 54 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4 AT Commands originating from GSM 07.07
These AT Commands are according to ETSI (European Telecommunications Standards Institute)
GSM 07.07 document.
4.1
AT+CACM Accumulated call meter (ACM) reset or query
Test command
Response
AT+CACM=?
OK
Parameter
Read command
Response
AT+CACM?
TA returns the current ACM value.
+CACM: <acm> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<acm>
string type; three bytes of the current ACM value in hexadecimal format (e.g. “00001E” indicates decimal value 30) 000000 – FFFFFF
Write command
Parameter
AT+CACM=
[<passwd>]
<passwd> string type:
SIM PIN2
Response
TA resets the Advice of Charge related to the accumulated call meter (ACM)
value in SIM file EF(ACM). ACM contains the total number of home units both
for the current and preceding calls.
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Reference
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 55 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.2
AT+CALA Set alarm time
Test command
AT+CALA=?
Test command returns supported array index values <n>, alarm types <type>,
and maximum length of the text <tlength> to be output.
Response
+CALA: (list of supported <n>s), (list of supported <type>s), (range of supported <tlength>) OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Read command returns the list of current active alarm settings in the ME.
AT+CALA?
Response
+CALA: <time>[,<n>[,<type>[,<text>]]]
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
Write command
AT+CALA=<time>
[,<n>[,<type>[,<te
xt>]]]
See write command
The write command sets an alarm time in the ME. When the alarm is timed out
and executed the ME returns an Unsolicited Result Code (URC). The alarm call
can adopt two functions, depending on whether or not you switch the GSM engine off after setting the alarm:
Reminder call: You can use the alarm function as a wake-up or reminder call.
For this purpose, set the alarm as described below and do not
switch off or power down the ME. When executed the call
comes as an Unsolicited Result Code.
Applies to MC35 and MC35 Terminal.
Alarm mode: You can use the alarm call to restart the ME when powered
down. For this purpose, set the alarm as described below. Then
power down the ME by entering the AT^SMSO command (pg.
191). When the alarm time is reached, the ME will wake up to
Alarm mode. To prevent the ME from unintentionally logging
into the GSM network, Alarm mode provides restricted operation. Upon wake-up, the ME indicates an Unsolicited Result
Code which reads: ^SYSSTART ALARM MODE. A limited
number of AT commands is available during Alarm mode:
AT+CCLK, AT+CALA, AT^SBC, AT^SCTM, AT^SMSO.
The ME remains deregistered from the GSM network. If you
want the ME to return to full operation (normal operating mode)
it is necessary to drive the ignition line (IGT pin of ZIF interface)
to ground. If your application is battery powered note that
charging cannot be started while ME is in Alarm mode. For details please refer to the "Hardware Interface Description" supplied with your GSM engine.
Applies to MC35 module only. MC35 Terminal does not support
the Alarm mode.
Response
OK
If setting fails:
+CME ERROR: <err> Refer to Chapter 9.1.1, pg. 214, for <err> values.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 56 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Parameter
<time>
string type value; format is "yy/MM/dd,hh:mm:ss", where characters
th
indicate year (two last digits), month, day, hour, minutes. E.g. 6 of
May 2001, 22:10:00 hours equals to “01/05/06,22:10:00" (see also
+CCLK). Note: if <time> equals current date and time or is to an earlier date, TA returns +CME ERROR: <21>.
<n>
integer type value indicating the array index of the alarm. Index starts
with 0. If only this value is returned by the test command, it is default
and indicates that only one alarm time is possible; however, if a second alarm time is set, the previous alarm is deleted.
<type>
integer type value indicating the type of the alarm
0 Alarm indication: text message via serial interface
<text>
string type value indicating the text to be displayed when alarm time
is reached; maximum length is <tlength>. After first connection to
power supply <text> is undefined.
Note: <text> will be stored to the non-volatile flash memory when the
device enters the Power Down mode via AT^SMSO (pg. 191). Once
saved, it will be available upon next power-up, until you overwrite it by
typing another text. This eliminates the need to enter the full string
when setting a fresh alarm and thus, saves memory due to the limited
number of flash memory write cycles (e.g. 100.000).
<tlength> integer type value indicating the maximum length of <text>. The
maximum length is 16.
Unsolicited result code
Indicates reminder call:
+CALA: <text>
Indicates ME wake-up into Alarm mode:
^SSYSTART ALARM MODE
+CALA: <text>
If autobauding is active (AT+IPR=0) the URCs ^SSYSTART ALARM MODE
and +CALA: <text> do not appear. Therefore, avoid using Alarm mode in conjunction with autobauding.
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
• <text> should not contain characters which are coded differently in ASCII
and GSM (e.g. Ä, Ö, Ü), see also Chapter 9.5.
• In the event of power outage the GSM engine retains the current alarm setting, but the RTC will be reset to <time> = “00/01/01,00:00:00” and must be
restored after resume of power (see also AT+CCLK, pg. 65. It is only in
Power Down mode, that the RTC is kept powered from a dedicated voltage
regulator, thus saving the current date and time.
• When the GSM engine wakes up to Alarm mode, the system takes 1s to reinitialize the RTC and to update the current time. Therefore, it is recommended to wait 1s before using the AT+CCLK command (for example 1s
after ^SSYSTART has been output).
• Please consider when using multiplex mode (+CMUX, pg. 91):
- It is possible to use +CALA with every logical channel (1 – 3).
- The total no. of possible alarm events is shared by all channels. If <n> =
0 is returned by the test command, this indicates that only one common
alarm time is possible for all logical channels.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 57 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
-
-
Examples
For every channel a different <text> parameter can be stored.
<text> will be output on the same logical channel the alarm was entered.
If not in multiplex mode, <text> will be output independent of the related
channel.
The read command returns all pending alarms, independent on which
logical channel an alarm was entered. It´s up to the user to identify these
alarms by specific <text>s.
Example 1:
You may want to configure a reminder call for May 31, 2001, at 9.30h, including
the message "Good Morning".
Write command:
AT+CALA="01/05/31,09:30:00",0,0,"Good Morning"
OK
Do not switch off the GSM engine. When the alarm is executed the ME returns
the following URC:
+CALA: Good Morning
Example 2:
To set a fresh alarm using the same message as in Example 1, simply enter
date and time. <n>, <type>, <text>, <tlength> can be omitted:
AT+CALA="01/05/31,08:50:00"
OK
When the alarm is executed the URC comes with the same message:
+CALA: Good Morning
Example 3:
To configure the alarm mode, e.g. for May 20, 2001, at 8.30h, enter
AT+CALA="01/05/20,08:30:00"
OK
Next, power down the ME:
AT^SMSO
^SMSO: MS OFF
When the alarm is executed the ME wakes up to Alarm mode and displays a
URC. If available, this line is followed by the individual <text> most recently
saved. If no individual message was saved only the first line appears.
^SYSSTART ALARM MODE
+CALA: Good Morning
Table 5: Summary of AT commands available in Alarm mode
AT command
AT+CALA
AT+CCLK
AT^SBC
AT^SCTM
AT^SMSO
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Use
Set alarm time
Set date and time of RTC
In Alarm mode, you can only query the present current consumption and check
whether or not a charger is connected. The battery capacity is returned as 0, regardless of the actual voltage (since the values measured directly on the cell are
not delivered to the module).
Query temperature of GSM engine
Power down GSM engine
Page 58 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.3
AT+CAMM Accumulated call meter maximum (ACMmax) set or query
Test command
Response
AT+CAMM=?
OK
Parameter
Read command
Response
AT+CAMM?
TA returns the current ACMmax value.
+CAMM: <acmmax> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+CAMM=
[<acmax>[,<passwd>]]
TA sets the Advice of Charge related to the accumulated call meter maximum value in SIM file EF (ACMmax). ACMmax contains the maximum
number of home units allowed to be consumed by the subscriber.
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<acmmax>
<passwd>
string type; three bytes of the max. ACM value in hexadecimal format (e.g. “00001E” indicates decimal value 30) 000000
disable ACMmax feature 000001-FFFFFF
string type
SIM PIN2
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 59 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.4
AT+CAOC Advice of Charge information
Test command
Response
AT+CAOC=?
+CAOC: (list of supported <mode>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CAOC?
+CAOC: <mode> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+CAOC=<mode> TA sets the Advice of Charge supplementary service function mode.
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
If <mode>=0, TA returns the current call meter value
OK
Parameter
<mode> 0 query CCM value
<ccm>
string type; three bytes of the current CCM value in hexadecimal
format (e.g. “00001E” indicates decimal value 30); bytes are similarly coded as ACMmax value in the SIM 000000-FFFFFF
Execute command
Response
AT+CAOC
TA returns the current call meter value
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
If <mode>=0, TA returns the current call meter value
+CAOC: <ccm> OK
Parameter
See write command
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 60 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.5
AT+CBST Select bearer service type
Test command
Response
AT+CBST=?
+CBST: (list of supported <speed>s),(list of supported <name>s),(list of supported <ce>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CBST?
+CBST: <speed>,<name>,<ce>
OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+CBST=
<speed>[,<name>
[,<ce>]]
TA selects the bearer service <name>, the data rate <speed> and the connection element <ce> to be used when data calls are originated. The settings also
apply to mobile terminated data calls, especially when single numbering
scheme calls or calls from analog devices are received (see also Chapter
4.45).
OK
Parameter
<speed> 0
4
2400 bps( V.22bis)
6
4800 bps( V.32)
7
9600 bps(V.32)
14
14400 bps (V.34)
68
2400 bps (V.110)
70
4800 bps (V.110)
71
9600 bps (V.110)
75
14400 bps (V.110)
<name> 0
<ce>
auto bauding
1
asynchronous modem
non-transparent
Transparent mode is not supported.
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
• GSM 02.02[1]: List of allowed combinations of subparameters.
• The PLMN influences the second air interface (to the terminator), therefore
another mode may be established by the network.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 61 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.6
AT+CCFC Call forwarding number and conditions control
Test command
Response
AT+CCFC=?
+CCFC: (list/range of supported <reas>s) OK
Parameter
See execute command
Write command
Response
AT+CCFC=<reas>,
<mode>[,<number>
[,<type>[,<class>
[,<time>]]]]
TA controls the call forwarding supplementary service. Registration, erasure,
activation, deactivation and status query are supported.
If <mode> ≠ 2 and command successful:
OK
If <mode> = 2, <reas> ≠ 2 and command successful:
+CCFC: <status>, <class1>[, <number>, <type>]
[<CR><LF>+CCFC: ....] OK
If <mode> = 2, <reas> = 2 and command successful:
+CCFC: <status>, <class1>[, <number>, <type> [, <time>]]
[<CR><LF>+CCFC: ....] OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<reas>
unconditional
mobile busy
no reply
not reachable
all call forwarding (includes reasons 0, 1, 2 and 3)
all conditional call forwarding (includes reasons 1, 2 and 3)
<mode> 0
1
2
3
4
disable call forwarding
enable call forwarding
query status of call forwarding
register <number> and activate call forwarding
erase <number> and deactivate call forwarding
<number>
string type phone number of forwarding address in format specified by <type>.
If you select <mode> = 3, the phone <number> will be registered
in the network. This allows you to disable / enable CF to the
same destination without the need to enter the phone number
once again. Depending on the services offered by the provider
the registration may be mandatory before CF can be used. The
number remains registered in the network until you register another number or erase it using <mode> = 4.
<type>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
0
1
2
3
4
5
type of address in integer format; default 145 when dialling string includes international access code character “+”, otherwise 129
Page 62 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
<class>
integer or sum of integers each representing a <class> of information:
1
voice
2
data
4
fax
8
short message service
16
data circuit sync
32
data circuit async
64
dedicated packet access
128
dedicated PAD access
x
combination of some of the above classes.
For example, the default setting 7 represents the sum of
the integers 1, 2 and 4 (CF for voice, data and fax). The
value 255 covers all classes. If the <class> parameter is
omitted, the default value 7 is used.
<time>
time to wait before call is forwarded, rounded to a multiple of 5 sec..
1...20..30 (only for <reas>=no reply)
<status> 0 not active
1 active
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07,
GSM 02.04,
GSM 02.82
• Please note that you can register, disable, enable and erase <reas>
4 and 5 as described above. However, it is not possible to query the status
of <reas> 4 and 5 with AT+CCFC. Instead, you may use the the ATD
command followed by *'# codes to check the status of these two reasons.
See Chapter 9.4 for a complete list of *# GSM codes. See also examples
below.
• The AT+CCFC command offers a broad range of call forwarding options
according to the GSM specifications. However, when you attempt to set a
call forwarding option which is not provisioned or not yet subscribed to, the
setting will not take effect regardless of the response returned. The responses in these cases vary with the network (for example “OK”, “Operation not allowed”, “Operation not supported” etc.). To make sure check the
the call forwarding status with <mode>=2.
4.6.1 Examples: Call forwarding
Please note that when you configure or query call forwarding without specifying any classes, the settings will refer to classes 1, 2 and 4 only (=default). The handling of classes is equivalent to AT+CLCK
(Chapter 4.21.3).
Example 1
To register the destination number for unconditional call forwarding (CFU):
at+ccfc=0,3,"+493012345678",145
OK
Remember that call forwarding will be activated for voice, data and fax (default classes) when you register the destination number.
Example 2
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
To query the status of CFU without specifying <class>:
at+ccfc=0,2
+CCFC: 1,1,"+493012345678",145
Page 63 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
+CCFC: 1,2,"+493012345678",145
+CCFC: 1,4,"+493012345678",145
OK
Example 3
To deactivate CFU without specifying <class>:
at+ccfc=0,0
OK
To check whether CFU was successfully deactivated (note that the destination number remains registered in the network when you disable CFU):
at+ccfc=0,2
+CCFC: 0,1,"+493012345678",145
+CCFC: 0,2,"+493012345678",145
+CCFC: 0,4,"+493012345678",145
OK
Example 4
To erase the registered CFU destination number:
at+ccfc=0,4
OK
Now, when you check the status, no destination number will be indicated:
at+ccfc=0,2
+CCFC: 0,1
+CCFC: 0,2
+CCFC: 0,4
Example 5
To query the status of CFU for all classes:
at+ccfc=0,2,,,255
+CCFC:
+CCFC:
+CCFC:
+CCFC:
+CCFC:
+CCFC:
+CCFC:
+CCFC:
OK
Example 6
0,1
0,2
0,4
0,8
0,16
0,32
0,64
0,128
<reas>=4 or 5 cannot be used to query the status of all call forwarding reasons (see also notes above):
at+ccfc=4,2
+CME error: operation not supported
at+ccfc=5,2
+CME error: operation not supported
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 64 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.7
AT+CCLK Real Time Clock
Test command
Response
AT+CCLK=?
OK
Read command
Response
AT+CCLK?
+CCLK: <time>
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter:
<time>:
string type value; format is "yy/MM/dd,hh:mm:ss", where characters
indicate year (two last digits), month, day, hour, minutes, seconds;
th
e.g. 6 of May 2001, 22:10:00 hours equals to “01/05/06,22:10:00"
Write command
Response
AT+CCLK=<time>
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter:
<time>
see read command
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
• <time> is retained if the device enters the Power Down mode via
AT^SMSO (pg. 192).
• <time> is lost if power is totally disconnected and if no separate battery
back-up for the clock is provided via the ZIF cable. In this case, the clock
starts with <time> = “00/01/01,00:00:00” upon next power-up.
• See AT+CALA, pg. 56.
• When the GSM engine wakes up to Alarm mode, the system takes 1s to
re-initialize the RTC and to update the current time. Therefore, it is recommended to wait 1s before using the AT+CCLK command (for example
1s after ^SSYSTART has been output).
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 65 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.8
AT+CCUG: Closed User Group
Test command
The Test command returns the supported parameters.
AT+CCUG=?
Response
+CCUG: (list of supported <n>s),(list of supported <index>),(list of supported
<info>) OK
Read command
AT+CCUG?
Explicit CUG invocation means that at each call setup, CUG information is
added to the called number.
The Read command returns if the Explicit CUG invocation is activated, which
CUG index is chosen, and if Preferential Group or Outgoing Access is suppressed.
Response
+CCUG: <n>, <index>,<info> OK
Write command
The write command serves to activate or deactivate the explicit CUG invocation, to set the desired index, and to specify if Preferential Group or Outgoing
AT+CCUG=
[,<n>[,<index>[,<in Access shall be suppressed.
fo>]]
Parameter
<n>
<index>
<info>
0
Deactivate explicit CUG invocation
1
Activate explicit CUG invocation
0...9 CUG index
10
No index (preferred CUG taken from subscriber data)
0
No information
1
Suppress Outgoing Access
2
Suppress preferential CUG
3
Suppress preferential CUG and Outgoing Access.
Response
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Reference
Note
GSM 02.85
Siemens
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 66 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.9
AT+CCWA Call waiting
Test command
Response
AT+CCWA=?
+CCWA: (list of supported <n>s)
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CCWA?
+CCWA: <n>
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
See write command
Write command
AT+CCWA=
[<n>,
[<mode>
[,<class>]]]
This command controls the Call Waiting supplementary service according to GSM
02.83. Activation, deactivation and status query are supported.
Response
+CCWA: <n>, <mode>,<class>,,<CLI validity>
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Response
If <mode>=2 and command is successful
+CCWA: <status>, <class1><CR><LF>
+CCWA: <status>, <class2><CR><LF>...
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
sets/shows the result code presentation status in the TA
0
disable
1
enable
<mode>
(when <mode> is not given, network is not interrogated)
0
disable
1
enable
2
query status
<class>
sum of integers each representing a class of information (default 7)
1
voice
2
data
4
fax
7
voice, data and fax (1+2+4)
8
SMS
16
data circuit sync
32
data circuit async
64
dedicated packet access
128 dedicated PAD access
<number>
string type phone number of calling address in format specified by
<type>
<type>
type of address octet in integer format (refer to GSM 04.08 subclause 10.5.4.7)
<CLI validity> 0
CLI valid
1
CLI has been withheld
2
CLI is not available
<status>
0
not active
1
active
Parameter <n> is used to disable/enable the presentation of the URC
+CCWA: <number>,<type>,<class>,,<CLI validity>
to the TE when call waiting service is enabled.
<n>
Reference
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 67 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.10 AT+CEER Extended error report
Test command
Response
AT+CEER=?
OK
Execute command
TA returns an extended error report of the reason for the last call release and
location.
AT+CEER
Response
+CEER: <location ID>, <reason > , <ss_release>OK
Parameter
<location ID>
Location ID as number code (see subclause 9.1.6)
<reason>
Reason for last call release as number code (see subclause
9.1.6)
<ss_release>
Release cause for last Supplementary Service Call
(see subclause 9.1.14)
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
• AT+CEER is not available for data calls, please use ATS18=1.
• Default output in the case of a no-error-situation is +CEER: 0,0,0.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 68 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.11 AT+CFUN Set phone functionality
The AT+CFUN command serves to query or set the level of functionality <fun> of the ME. You can
reset the ME or enable power saving.
Full functionality
<fun>=1
Full functionality is where high current is drawn, depending on the power level and
the operating mode, e.g. IDLE, TALK, DATA, IDLE GPRS or DATA GPRS mode.
SLEEP mode and wake-ups
Intended for power saving, SLEEP mode reduces the functionality of the ME to a minimum and,
thus, minimizes the current consumption to the lowest level. SLEEP mode can be selected in the
three levels <fun>=0, 5 or 6:
<fun>=0:
If <fun>=0 has been selected, the serial interface is blocked. The ME shortly wakes
up to listen to a paging message block sent from the base station and immediately
returns to the power saving mode.
The first wake-up event fully activates the ME, enables the serial interface and terminates power saving. Level 0 is called NON-CYCLIC SLEEP mode.
<fun>=5 or 6:
Wake-ups:
These two options are referred to as CYCLIC SLEEP modes. The major benefit over
the NON-CYCLIC SLEEP mode is that the serial interface is not permanently
blocked and that packet switched calls may go on without terminating the power
saving mode. This allows you to take advantage of power saving, for example, while
the ME remains attached to the GPRS and even performs a GPRS data transfer.
The CYCLIC SLEEP mode is a dynamic process which alternatingly enables and
disables the serial interface. The application must be configured to use hardware
flow control. By setting/resetting the CTS signal, the module indicates to the application when the UART is active. The application must wait until CTS is set (i.e. is active low) on the physical UART before data can be sent to the module.
The module starts or resumes power saving two seconds (AT+CFUN=5) or ten minutes (AT+CFUN=6) after the last sent or received character. The module resets the
CTS signal, and after additional 5ms it physically deactivates the UART to save
power.
Wake-up procedures are the same as in the NON-CYCLIC SLEEP mode. The first
wake-up event fully activates the module, enables the serial interface and terminates
power saving. As an additional option, you can set AT+CFUN=1 to wake up the
module.
While the SLEEP mode is in effect, there are number of ways to wake up the ME:
incoming call (RING), incoming SMS, RTC alarm, receipt of an unsolicited result
code (URC). See Chapter 9.1.4 for a summary of URCs.
During the NON-CYCLIC SLEEP mode (<fun=0>), a falling edge of the RTS line
also wakes up the GSM engine. In the CYCLIC SLEEP modes (<fun>=5 or 6), the
RTS signal is only used for handshake and does not wake up the ME
IMPORTANT: The SLEEP modes <fun>=0, 5 and 6 can be selected no matter whether or not PIN
authentication has been done. Nevertheless, please keep in mind that power saving works only
while the module is registered to the GSM network. If you attempt to activate power saving while the
module is detached, the selected <fun> option will be set, though power saving does not take effect.
Furthermore, in order to accept incoming calls, SMS or network related URCs in SLEEP mode the
ME must be registered when it enters the SLEEP mode.
To check that power saving is on, it is recommended to measure the supply current. If available, you
can take advantage of the status LED controlled by the SYNC pin (see Chapter 8.37 and [1]. The
LED stops flashing once the module starts power saving.
For detailed information on the various operating modes, current consumption, the timing of the CTS
signal and a summary of wake-up events from SLEEP mode, please refer to [1].
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 69 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Test command
Response
AT+CFUN=?
+CFUN: (list of supported <fun>s), (list of supported <rst>s)
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
See below
Read command
Response
AT+CFUN?
+CFUN: <fun>
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
See below
Write command
AT+CFUN=[<fun>
[,<rst>]]
The write command can be used to reset the ME, to choose one of the SLEEP
mode levels or to return to full functionality. For <fun>=5 or 6 the application
must be configured to use hardware flow control. This is necessary for the CTS
signal level to be transparently transmitted to the TE.
Response
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<fun>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
0
NON-CYCLIC SLEEP mode:
AT+CFUN=0 disconnects immediately any circuit or packet
switched call in progress. The ME goes into power saving
mode. While the NON-CYCLIC SLEEP mode is on, the AT
interface is not accessible. Consequently, once you have
set <fun> level 0, do not send further characters. Otherwise
these characters remain in the input buffer and may delay
the output of an unsolicited result code.
The first wake-up event stops power saving. The ME is
caused to return to full functionality and to stay fully operational.
1
Full functionality:
ME operates in IDLE, TALK, DATA, IDLE GPRS or DATA
GPRS mode.
If the ME is in one of the two CYCLIC SLEEP modes you
can issue AT+CFUN=1 to stop power saving and go back to
full functionality. Keep in mind that, unlike the reset
command described below, this action does not restart the
ME but only changes the level of functionality. See
parameter <rst> for details on the reset.
5
CYCLIC SLEEP mode:
AT+CFUN=5 disconnects any circuit-switched call in progress, but has no effect on a GPRS call. The ME goes into
the power saving mode 2 seconds after the last character
was transmitted over the serial interface. Sending characters over the serial interface resets the timer.
The first wake-up event stops power saving. Also, you can
enter AT+CFUN=1 to terminate power saving.
Page 70 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
<rst>
6
CYCLIC SLEEP mode:
AT+CFUN=6 disconnects any circuit-switched call in progress, but has no effect on a GPRS call. The ME goes into
the power saving mode 10 minutes after the last character
was transmitted over the serial interface. Sending characters over the serial interface resets the timer.
The first wake-up event stops power saving. Also, you can
enter AT+CFUN=1 to terminate power saving.
0
The <rst> parameter can only be used if +CFUN=1, 5 or 6.
Due to the command syntax, you need to enter <fun>,
followed by <rst>, where <fun> is only a placeholder and
has no effect. See examples below.
1
ME resets and restarts to full functionality.
After reset and restart, PIN 1 authentication is necessary.
Therefore, you are required to use AT+CPIN again. If
autobauding is enabled it is recommended to wait 3 to 5
seconds before entering the first AT command. For details
on autobauding refer to Chapter 2.45.1
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
• In multiplex mode, the CFUN profile is shared by all multiplexer channels.
When you change the CFUN state on one logical channel, all other logical
channels adopt the same state.
Example 1
To check the level of functionality use the read command:
AT+CFUN?
+CFUN: 1
Default mode after ME was restarted.
Remember that the AT interface is not accessible in NON-CYCLIC SLEEP
mode. Consequently, the read command is only useful when the ME is set to
full functionality or, when <fun> is set to 5or 6.
AT+CFUN?
+CFUN: 5
Example 2
CYCLIC SLEEP mode.
To set the ME to NON-CYCLIC SLEEP mode enter
AT+CFUN=0
OK
When, for example, an SMS is being received and indicated by an unsolicited
result code (URC), the ME wakes up to full operation.
+CMTI: "SM",5
Note that the URC used in this example will appear
only if CMTI=1,1 was configured before. See Chapters
5.10 and 9.1.4.
After this, you may want to verify the operating status:
AT+CFUN?
+CFUN: 1
Indicates that ME has entered full functionality mode.
Example 3
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
To enable CYCLIC SLEEP mode, level 6:
AT+CFUN=6
OK
Page 71 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Power saving begins 10 minutes after the last character was sent or received
over the serial interface.
Example 4
To stop CYCLIC SLEEP mode and return to full functionality:
AT+CFUN?
+CFUN: 5
OK
AT+CFUN=1
OK
Remember that this approach is not applicable to the NON-CYCLIC SLEEP
mode (since the serial interface is disabled). The NON-CYCLIC SLEEP mode
ends with the first wake-up event.
Example 5
To reset and restart the ME:
AT+CFUN=1,1 or alternatively, AT+CFUN=0,1 or 5,1 or 6,1
OK
^SSYSTART
The ^SSYSTART URC confirms that the ME has been
rebooted.
Note that ^SSYSTART appears only if AT+IPR≠
≠0. If the
ME is in autobaud mode, it is recommended to wait 3 to
5 seconds before entering the first AT command.
After the GSM engine was reset and restarted you are required to enter PIN 1:
AT+CPIN
+CPIN: SIM PIN
OK
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 72 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.12 AT+CGMI Request manufacturer identification
Test command
Response
AT+CGMI=?
OK
Execute command
Response
AT+CGMI
TA returns manufacturer identification text.
SIEMENS
OK
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
See also ”AT+GMI Request manufacturer identification”.
4.13 AT+CGMM Request model identification
Test command
Response
AT+CGMM=?
OK
Execute command
Response
AT+CGMM
TA returns product model identification text.
MC35
OK
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
See also ”AT+GMM Request TA model identification”.
4.14 AT+CGMR Request revision identification of software status
Test command
Response
AT+CGMR=?
OK
Execute command
Response
AT+CGMR
TA returns product firmware version identification text.
REVISION xx.yy
OK
xx.yy
Version xx and variant yy of software release
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
See also AT+GMR Request TA revision identification of software status
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 73 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.15 AT+CGSN Request product serial number identification (IMEI) identical
to GSN
Test command
Response
AT+CGSN=?
OK
Execute command
Response
AT+CGSN
TA returns identification text for determination of the individual ME.
<sn> OK
Parameter
<sn> IMEI of the telephone (International Mobile station Equipment Identity)
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
See also ”AT+GSN Request TA serial number identification”.
4.16 AT+CHLD Call hold and multiparty
Test command
Response
AT+CHLD=?
+CHLD: (list of supported <n>s)
OK
Execute command
Response
AT+CHLD=[<n>]
TA controls the supplementary services Call Hold, MultiParty and Explicit Call
Transfer. Calls can be put on hold, recovered, released, added to conversation
and transferred.
Note: Supplementary services are only applicable to teleservice 11 (Speech telephony).
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<n>
0
Terminate all held calls; or set UDUB (User Determined User
Busy) for a waiting call, i.e. reject the waiting call.
1
Terminate all active calls (if any) and accept the other call
(waiting call or held call)
1X
Terminate the active call X (X= 1-7)
2
Place all active calls on hold (if any) and accept the other call
(waiting call or held call) as the active call
2X
Place all active calls except call X (X= 1-7) on hold
3
Add the held call to the active calls
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
• In conflicting situations, e.g. when a waiting call comes while there are already
held calls, the above procedures apply to the waiting call only. For example,
<n>=0 rejects the waiting call, but does not affect the held calls.
• While the PDP context for GPRS is activated it is recommended to terminate
any calls with AT+CHLD=1 rather than usind ATH. This is significant because
ATH would also cancel an active PDP context. See also Chapters 2.12 and
6.3.2.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 74 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.17 AT+CHUP Hang up call
Test command
Response
AT+CHUP=?
OK
Execute command
Cancels all active and held calls.
AT+CHUP
Response
OK/ERROR
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
AT+CHUP implements the same behaviour as ATH (see Chapter 2.12).
4.18 AT+CIMI Request international mobile subscriber identity
Test command
Response
AT+CIMI=?
OK
Execute command
Response
AT+CIMI
TA returns < IMSI> for identifying the individual SIM which is attached to ME.
<IMSI> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<IMSI> International Mobile Subscriber Identity (string without quotes)
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 75 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.19 AT+CIND Indicator control
MC35 offers two ways of displaying status and event reporting messages by indicators. With
AT+CIND? you can directly query the current status of each indicator. With AT+CMER you can enable or disable the presentation of these indicators in the form of the Unsolicited Result Code
+CIEV. See Chapter 4.25 for instructions.
MC35 supports indicator event reporting for the following items: battery capacity, signal quality,
service availability, generation of sound in the ME, indication of unread SMS, full SMS storage, call
in progress and roaming activities. Whenever a status change or event occurs, MC35 sends the associated URC to the application (if enabled with AT+CMER).
Please note that the AT+CMER command enables the presentation of +CIEV URCs only if the indicators are registered with the AT+CIND write command. By default, all of them are registered. Any
URCs you do not need can easily be excluded if deregistered with <stat>=0.
Test command
Response
AT+CIND=?
+CIND: (<descr>,(list
<ind>s))[,...]]
of
supported
<ind>s))
[,(<descr>,(list
of
supported
Parameters
See read command
Read command
Response
AT+CIND?
TA returns the status of the ME indicators.
+CIND: <ind>[,<ind>[,...]]
OK
If error is related to ME functionality
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<ind>
integer type value, which shall be in range of corresponding <descr>
<descr> values reserved by this ETS and their <ind> ranges:
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
"battchg"
battery charge level (0-5),
where (0-5) means 0, 20, 40, 60 or 100 per cent
of the the remaining battery capacity. If no battery
is connected to the ME, then the value will be always equal to 5. See also Chapter 8.5.
"signal"
signal quality (0-7 or 99 if not measurable). The
indicated value is the bit error rate of the signal
quality. See also Chapter 4.46.
"service"
service availability (0-1)
"sounder"
sounder activity (0-1)
"message"
unread message (0-1)
"call"
call in progress (0-1). Voice und data calls only.
"roam"
roaming indicator (0-1)
"smsfull"
a short message memory storage in the MT has
become full (1) or memory locations are available
(0); i.e. the range is (0-1)
Page 76 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Write command
AT+CIND=
[<stat>[,<stat>
[,...]]]
The write command simply controls the registration / deregistration of indicators.
<stat>
0
Indicator is deregistered. The indicator cannot be presented as
+CIEV URC, but can be directly queried with AT+CIND?.
1
Indicator is registered, indicator event report is allowed.
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
The indicator “call” changes its value as soon as a call has been established, that
is when both interlocutors are connected.
The indicator “sounder” appears each time a tone is generated in the ME. For instance, a waiting call produces a tone, which will be thus indicated.
Examples
^SYSSTART
at+cpin=9999
OK
at+cind?
+CIND: 5,99,1,0,0,0,0,0
OK
at+cmer=2,0,0,2
at+cmer
OK
+CIEV: message,0
+CIEV: battchg,5
+CIEV: signal,99
+CIEV: service,1
+CIEV: sounder,0
+CIEV: call,0
+CIEV: roam,0
+CIEV: smsfull,0
The battery is either full or an external supply
source is used. The bit error rate of the signal
quality is not available (since there no call in
progress), and the ME is registered to its home
network.
Now, activate the Indicator Event Report with
atd"0123456";
OK
You make a call.
+CIEV:
+CIEV:
+CIEV:
+CIEV:
A set of +CIEV URCs reports is presented.
sounder,1
call,1
sounder,0
call,0
NO CARRIER
at+cind=,,,0,,0
OK
atd"0123456";
OK
The receiver hangs up.
You deregister
‘sounder’
the
indicators
‘call’
and
You make a call.
This time, no +CIEV URCs are displayed.
NO CARRIER
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 77 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.20 AT+CLCC List current calls of ME
Test command
Response
AT+CLCC=?
OK
Parameters
Execute command
Response
AT+CLCC
TA returns a list of current calls of ME. If command successful, but no calls are
available, no information response is sent to TE.
[+CLCC: <id1>,<dir>,<stat>,<mode>,<mpty>,
[<number>,<type>,[<alpha>]]]
[<CR><LF>+CLCC: <id2>,<dir>,<stat>,<mode>,<mpty>,
[<number>,<type>,[<alpha>]]]
[...]]] OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameters
<idx>
<dir>
<stat>
<mode>
<mpty>
<number>
<type>
<alpha>
Reference
Integer type; call identification number as described in GSM
02.30[19] subclause 4.5.5.1; this number can be used in +CHLD
command operations
0 mobile originated (MO) call
1 mobile terminated (MT) call
state of the call:
0 active
1 held
2 dialing (MO call)
3 alerting (MO call)
4 incoming (MT call)
5 waiting (MT call)
bearer/teleservice:
0 voice
1 data
2 fax
9 unknown
0 call is not one of multiparty (conference) call parties
1 call is one of multiparty (conference) call parties
string type phone number in format specified by <type>
type of address octet in integer format; 145 when dialling string
includes international access code character “+”, otherwise 129
string type alphanumeric representation of <number> corresponding to the entry found in phonebook; used character set
should be the one selected with command Select TE Character
Set +CSCS
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 78 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.21 AT+CLCK Facility lock
Test command
Response
AT+CLCK=?
+CLCK: (list of supported <fac>s) OK
Parameter
Execute command
AT+CLCK=<fac>,
<mode>
[,<passwd>
[,<class>]]
See execute command
Use this command to lock, unlock or interrogate a ME or a network facility
<fac>. The command can be aborted when network facilities are being set or
interrogated.
Response
If <mode> ≠ 2 and command is successful
OK
If <mode> = 2 and command is successful
+CLCK: <status>[,<class1>[<CR><LF>
+CLCK: <status>, class2....]] OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<fac> Phone security locks set by client or factory:
“SC” SIM (lock SIM cards). SIM requests password upon ME powerup and when this lock command is issued. "SC" lock is protected
with SIM PIN1. The number can be modified with AT+CPWD or
AT^SPWD. See examples in Chapter 4.21.2 for further explanations.
“PS” Phone locked to SIM card. ME requests password when other
than current SIM card is inserted.
If set individually by the client, the password for the "PS" lock
can be specified with AT+CPWD or AT^SPWD.
If set by factory (e.g. for a prepaid mobile), the password is supplied by the provider or operator.
“FD” SIM fixed dialling memory: If the mobile is locked to "FD", only
the phone numbers stored to the "FD" memory can be dialled
(depending on the SIM card, usually up to 7 numbers). If PIN2
authentication has not been performed during the current session, PIN2 is requested as <passwd>.
"CS" Keypad lock (not supported since keypad cannot be directly
connected to the GSM engine)
Note:
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Primarily intended for the client to take safety precautions, "SC",
"PS" and "FD" can be configured individually. "PS" may also be
factory set.
"PS" lock is frequently referred to as "phone lock", or "device
lock". Accordingly, the password may be called "phone code" or
"device code". The "PS" password is not associated with the
PUK of the SIM card. If incorrectly entered three times, the
Master Phone Code is required to lift the lock. Once the Master
Phone Code has been acctepted, the mobile is operational, and
the "PS" lock is no longer active. If needed it must be set once
again. See Chapter 4.35.1 and examples below for further details.
Page 79 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Factory set SIM locks
“PF” lock Phone to the very First SIM card
“PN” Network Personalisation
“PU” Network subset Personalisation
“PP” Service Provider Personalisation
“PC” Corporate Personalisation
Note:
Typical examples of factory set SIM locks are prepaid phones or
network locks, used to restrict the operation of a mobile to a specific provider or operator. The client should be aware that each of
these lock types can only be unlocked if the associated password is available. For example, a mobile can be locked to accept
only SIM cards from the respective provider, or even one single
SIM card. Once a different SIM card is inserted the ME will
prompt the client to enter a specific code. This is not the PUK of
the SIM card, but usually an 8-digit code which needs to be requested from the provider.
The locks can only be set by the manufacturer and need to be
agreed upon between the parties concerned, e.g. provider, operator, distributor etc. on the one side and the manufacturer on
the other side. For details contact your local dealer or Siemens
AG.
See Chapter 4.35 and 4.35.1 for further instructions.
Supplementary Service: Call barring:
“AO” BAOC (Bar All Outgoing Calls)
“OI” BOIC (Bar Outgoing International Calls)
“OX” BOIC-exHC (Bar Outgoing International Calls except to Home
Country)
“AI” BAIC (Bar All Incoming Calls)
“IR” BIC-Roam (Bar Incoming Calls when Roaming outside the home
country)
“AB” All Barring services (applicable only for <mode>=0)
“AG” All outGoing barring services (applicable only for <mode>=0)
“AC” All inComing barring services (applicable only for <mode>=0)
Note:
The availability of the Supplementary Services varies with the
network. To benefit from call barring the client will need to subscribe them, though a limited number of call barring types may
be included in the basic tariff package. Call barring is protected
by a password supplied from the provider or operator. Usually
there is one password which applies to all call barring options.
For details contact your provider.
<mode> 0 unlock
1 lock
2 query status
<passwd> password
See Chapters 4.38 and 8.35 for instructions of how to specify passwords.
<class>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
integer or sum of integers each representing a <class> of information:
1
voice
2
data
4
fax
8
short message service
16
data circuit sync
Page 80 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
32
64
128
x
data circuit async
dedicated packet access
dedicated PAD access
combination of some of the above classes.
For example, the default setting 7 represents the sum of the
integers 1, 2 and 4 (call barring for voice, data and fax). The
value 255 covers all classes. If the <class> parameter is
omitted, the default value 7 is used.
See examples in 4.21.3 for correct handling of class numbers.
<status> 0 off
1 on
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
*# codes sent with ATD cannot be used to enter the Master Phone Code.
4.21.1 Examples: Enabling / disabling PIN 1 authentication
Example 1
Example 2
To lock or unlock the SIM card: The "SC" parameter enables or disables the
SIM PIN authentication (PIN 1) when you power up the GSM engine:
AT+CLCK="SC",1,9999
Activates SIM card lock.
OK
As a result, SIM PIN 1 must be entered to enable ME to register to the GSM network.
AT+CLCK="SC",0,9999
Unlocks SIM card.
OK
When powered up, ME registers to the GSM
network without requesting SIM PIN1.
Note: Depending on the services offered by the
provider, this feature is not supported by all
SIM card types. If so, the command returns
ERROR when you attempt to unlock the card.
To query the status of the SIM card lock:
AT+CLCK="SC",2
+clck: 1
SIM card is locked. SIM PIN1 must be entered
to enable ME to register to the GSM network.
4.21.2 Examples: Phone lock
Example 1
Be sure that PIN 1 authentication is valid:
AT+CPIN?
+CPIN: SIM PIN
OK
AT+CPIN=9999
OK
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 81 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
To lock the mobile to the currently inserted SIM card, first specify a password (=
a phone code):
AT+CPWD="PS",,1234
If "PS" lock has not been set before: enter new
OK
password.
or:
AT+CPWD="PS",1234,3333 To replace existing "PS" password: Enter old
OK
and new one.
Then, activate the phone lock:
AT+CLCK="PS",1,3333
Locks the mobile to the current SIM card.
OK
Example 2
To deactivate the phone lock:
AT+CLCK="PS",0,3333
Enter lock type "PS", followed by 0 to lift the
OK
lock. Then type "PS" lock password.
As a result, the mobile accepts any SIM card and can be operated after the
card's SIM PIN 1 was entered.
Example 3
Example 4
To operate the mobile with the SIM card for which "PS" lock was activated:
AT+CPIN?
Enter SIM PIN used when locking the mobile.
+CPIN: SIM PIN
AT+CPIN=9999
OK
"PS"lock password is not needed.
To operate the mobile with other SIM card than the one used for the "PS" lock:
Enter SIM PIN of present card, followed by "PS" lock password.
AT+CPIN?
+CPIN: SIM PIN
AT+CPIN=1111
Enter SIM PIN of present SIM card.
OK
SIM PIN accepted.
AT+CPIN?
Example 5
+CPIN: PH-SIM PIN
AT+CPIN=3333
"PS" lock password is required.
OK
"PS" lock password has been accepted.
Attempt to unblock the "PS" lock using an invalid password:
AT+CPIN?
+CPIN: SIM PIN
AT+CPIN=1111
Enter SIM PIN of present SIM card.
OK
SIM PIN accepted.
AT+CPIN?
+CPIN: PH-SIM PIN
"PS" lock password is required.
AT+CPIN=4444
Bad password is given:
+CME ERROR: incorrect password
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 82 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
After the "PS" lock password was incorrectly entered three times in a row:
AT+CPIN?
+CPIN: PH-SIM PUK
Master Phone Code is required (8-digit code
available from the manufacturer. See Chapter
4.35.1).
AT+CPIN=12345678
Master Phone Code has been accepted. As a
result, the mobile is operational, and the "PS"
lock is totally removed. If needed, it must be set
once again.
Example 6
Attempt to unblock the "PS" lock using an invalid Master Phone Code: Due to
the timing algorithm explained in Chapter 4.35.1 the intervals between each
attempt are getting longer. See also AT^SPIC in Chapter 8.31.
Example 7
As an alternative to the AT+CPIN command you can use AT+CPWD. In this
case the following syntax shall be observed: AT+CPWD=PS,Master Phone
Code[,new password].
Deactivates the "PS" lock.
AT+CPWD=PS,12345678
Or
AT+CPWD=PS,12345678,3333
Deactivates the present "PS" lock
and sets a new "PS" lock.
4.21.3 Examples: Call barring
Please note that when you configure or query call barring without specifying any classes, the settings
will refer to classes 1, 2 and 4 only (default setting).
Remember that most of the call barring types have to be subscribed to. Usually, the service is subject
to a password supplied from the provider.
Example 1
When checking the status of barring for outgoing international calls without
specifying classes, please note that the ME returns only the status of voice,
data, fax calls. The status of SMS and other classes will not be indicated.
at+clck=oi,2,0000
or without <passwd>: at+clck=oi,2
+CLCK: 1,1
outgoing international voice calls barred
+CLCK: 1,2
outgoing international data calls barred
+CLCK: 1,4
outgoing international fax calls barred
OK
Example 2
To check the call barring status of all services, you are required to enter the integer sum referring to all classes:
at+clck=oi,2,0000,15
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
or without <passwd>: at+clck=oi,2,,15
Page 83 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
+CLCK:
+CLCK:
+CLCK:
+CLCK:
OK
Example 3
Example 4
Example 5
outgoing international voice calls barred
outgoing international data calls barred
outgoing international fax calls barred
outgoing international SMS barred
To activate call barring for outgoing international voice and data calls:
at+clck=oi,1,0000,3
(where 3 is the sum of class 1 + class 2)
OK
To disable call barring for outgoing international fax (class 4) and SMS (class 8)
calls:
at+clck=oi,0,0000,12
(where 12 is the sum of class 4 + class 8)
OK
To check whether actions in example 3 and 4 were successful, check the status
of barring for all outgoing international calls:
at+clck=oi,2,0000,15
+CLCK:
+CLCK:
+CLCK:
+CLCK:
OK
Example 6
1,1
1,2
1,4
1,8
1,1
1,2
0,4
0,8
outgoing international voice calls barred
outgoing international data calls barred
outgoing international fax calls are allowed
outgoing international SMS are allowed
To allow outgoing international calls without specifying classes:
at+clck=oi,0,0000,15
OK
To query status without specifying classes:
at+clck=oi,2
+CLCK: 0,1
outgoing international voice calls allowed
+CLCK: 0,2
outgoing international data calls allowed
+CLCK: 0,4
outgoing international fax calls allowed
To query status for all classes:
at+clck=oi,2,0000,15
+CLCK: 0,1
+CLCK: 0,2
+CLCK: 0,4
+CLCK: 0,8
OK
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 84 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.22 AT+CLIP Calling line identification presentation
Test command
AT+CLIP=?
This command refers to the GSM supplementary service CLIP (Calling Line
Identification Presentation) that enables a called subscriber to get the calling line
identity (CLI) of the calling party when receiving a mobile terminated call.
Response
+ CLIP: (list of supported <n>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CLIP?
+CLIP: <n>, <m> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
Write command
AT+CLIP=<n>
See write command
Set command enables or disables the presentation of the CLI at the TE. It has no
effect on the execution of the supplementary service CLIP in the network.
Response
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<n>
0 suppress unsolicited result codes
1 display unsolicited result codes
<m>
0 CLIP not provisioned
1 CLIP provisioned
2 unknown
Unsolicited result
code
When CLIP is enabled at the TE (and is permitted by the calling subscriber), an
unsolicited result code is returned after every RING (or +CRING: <type>) at a
mobile terminating call.
Voice call response format:
+CLIP: <number>, <type>,,,,<CLI validity>
Data/FAX call response format:
+CLIP: <number>, <type>
Parameter
string type phone number of calling address in format specified by
<type>
<type>
type of address octet in integer format; 145 when dialling string includes international access code character “+”, otherwise 129.
<CLI validity>
<number>
Reference
0
CLI valid
1
CLI has been withheld by the originator.
3
CLI is not available due to interworking problems or limitations
of originating network. <number> shall be an empty string ("")
and <type> value will not be significant.
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 85 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.23 AT+CLIR Calling line identification restriction (by *# sequence)
The AT+CLIR command is not supported. Instead, you can handle CLIR on a call-by-call basis using
the ATD command and a *# sequence.
Read command
Run the Read command to query status:
ATD*#31#
Response
+CLIR: <n>,<m>
Defined values
<n>
(parameter shows the settings for outgoing calls):
<m>
0
presentation indicator is used according to the
subscription of the CLIR service
1
CLIR invocation
2
CLIR suppression
(parameter shows the subscriber CLIR service status in
the network):
0
CLIR not provisioned
1
CLIR provisioned in permanent mode
2
unknown (e.g. no network, etc.)
3
CLIR temporary mode presentation restricted
4
CLIR temporary mode presentation allowed
Execute commands
The Execute commands allow you to enable or disable the presentation of your phone number to the called party when you set up a call:
ATD*31#<Phonenumber>[;]
Deactivate CLIR = enable presentation of own phone number
to called party
ATD#31#<Phonenumber>[;]
Activate CLIR = suppress presentation of own phone number to
called party
Note:
<Phonenumber> = phone number of called party
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 86 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.24 AT+CLVL Loudspeaker volume level
Test command
Response
AT+CLVL=?
+CLVL: (list of supported <level>s)OK
Read command
Response
AT+CLVL?
+CLVL: <level>
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Write command
Response
AT+CLVL=<level>
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<level> Loudspeaker Volume Level (0-4)
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
• The volume level cannot be modified in audio mode 1.
• The changed volume level will not be saved with AT^SNFW, instead it
will be saved after AT^SMSO only.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 87 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.25 AT+CMER Mobile equipment event reporting
Test command
Response
AT+CMER=?
+CMER: (list of supported <mode>s),(list of supported <keyp>s),
(list of supported <disp>s),(list of supported <ind>s),(list of supported <bfr>s)
Parameter
See execute command
Read command
Response
AT+CMER?
+CMER: <mode>,<keyp>,<disp>,<ind>,<bfr>
Parameter
See execute command
Write command
AT+CMER=
[<mode>
[,<keyp>
[,<disp> [,<ind>
[,<bfr>]]]]]
Enables or disables the presentation of event reports to the TE in the form of
+CIEV Unsolicited Result Codes. See the <desc>> parameter for the list of
indicators.
Response
OK
Parameter
0
discard CIEV unsolicited result codes
1
discard CIEV unsolicited result codes when TA-TE link is
reserved (e.g. in on-line data mode); otherwise forward them
directly to the TE
2
Buffer CIEV unsolicited result codes in the TA when TA-TE link
is reserved (e.g. in on-line data mode) and flush them to the
TE after reservation. Otherwise forward them directly to the
TE.
3
forward CIEV unsolicited result codes directly to the TE; TA-TE
link specific inband technique used to embed result codes and
data when TA is in on-line data mode
<keyp>
0
no keypad event reporting
<disp>
0
no display event reporting
<ind>
0
no indicator event reporting
2
indicator event reporting using result code
+CIEV: <desc>,<value>
<desc> indicates the indicator’s name and <value> is the new
value of this indicator.All indicator events shall be directed from
TA to TE.
<bfr>
0
TA buffer of unsolicited result codes defined within this
command; is cleared when <mode> 1...3 is entered
<desc>
values reserved by this ETS and their <value> ranges:
"battchg"
battery charge level (5 only = no level measuring)
"signal"
signal quality (0-7 or 99 if not measurable)
"service"
service availability (0-1)
"sounder"
sounder activity (0-1)
"message"
unread message (0-1)
"call"
call in progress (0-1). Voice und data calls only.
"roam"
roaming indicator (0-1)
"smsfull"
a short message memory storage in the MT has
become full (1) or memory locations are available
(0); i.e. the range is (0-1)
<mode>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 88 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Reference
Unsolicited Result Code:
GSM 07.07
+CIEV: <desc>,<value>
Note
Only the indicators which are registered (see AT+CIND command), will be reported if CMER is enabled.
While the ME is in online data mode, and CMER’s <mode> equals to 3, no URC
will be displayed on the TE, but they will be available after ‘+++’ has been entered.
After CMER has been switched on, URCs for all registered indicators with their
default value, will be presented to the TE.
4.26 AT+CMEE Report mobile equipment error
Test command
Response
AT+CMEE=?
+CMEE: (list of supported <n>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CMEE?
+CMEE: <n> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
AT+CMEE=<n>
This command controls the presentation of the result codes +CME ERROR:
<err> and CMS:<err> that indicate errors relating to ME functionality.
When you power down or reset the ME with AT+CFUN=1,1 the setting will be reset to its default. The levels 1 or 2 need to be selected every time you reboot the
ME, or may be included, for permanent use, in the user profile saved with AT&W.
Response
OK
Parameter
<n>
0 disable result code (only 'ERROR' will be displayed)
1 enable result code and use numeric values
2 enable result code and use verbose values
Example
To obtain enhanced error messages it is recommended to choose <n>=2.
AT+CMEE=2
OK
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
• The possible error result codes are listed in chapter 9
• In multiplex mode (see “AT+CMUX Enter multiplex mode”, pg. 91) the setting
applies only to the logical channel where selected. The setting on the other
channels may differ.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 89 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.27 AT+CMUT Mute control
Test command
Response
AT+CMUT=?
+CMUT: (list of supported <n>s)
OK
Read command
Response
AT+CMUT?
+CMUT: <n>
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Write command
Response
AT+CMUT=<n>
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<n>:
0 mute off
1 mute on
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 90 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.28 AT+CMUX Enter multiplex mode
MC35 supports Multiplex mode according to the GSM 07.10 Multiplexer Protocol and enables one
physical serial asynchronous interface to be partitioned into three virtual channels. This allows you
to take advantage of up to 3 simultaneous sessions running on the serial interface. Each session
represents a stream of bytes conveying various data; such as voice, fax, data, SMS, phonebook information, battery status etc. For example, you can transfer data over one channel while two further
channels are free to control the GSM engine with AT commands. It should be noted, however, that
voice, data, fax or GPRS calls cannot be established simultaneously, since the mobile device provides just one air interface to the network.
To make the three virtual interfaces (channels) available, both the MC35 module and the customer
application must contain Mux components which communicate over the Multiplexer Protocol. In the
MC35 module, the Mux/MP software is already incorporated. The customer application should either
integrate the MC35 Mux/MP software or include a Mux/MP program developed by the customer. The
AT+CMUX write command starts the multiplexing protocol control channel.
Refer to [5] which provides to a detailed description of the Multiplex functionality implemented in
MC35 and step-by-step instructions of how to install and configure the MUX mode. The source files
of the MC35 Mux/MP software can be supplied on request. Please contact your local dealer to obtain the latest installation software and user's guide.
Test command
Response
AT+CMUX=?
+CMUX: (list of supported <mode>s) OK
Read command
Response
AT+CMUX?
+CMUX: <mode> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Write command
Response
AT+CMUX=<mode>
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<mode>
multiplexer transparency mechanism
0
basic option
Subparameters defined in GSM07.07 are adjusted for control and logical
channels as follows:
<subset>
0
UIH frames used only (control channel)
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
1. The write command is used to enter the multiplex mode. The setup of
the logical channels is initiated by the TE, i.e. the TE acts as initiator.
This means that the TE shall ensure that logical channels are established before any further actions on the channels can be started.
2. There is a timeout of five seconds, if the multiplexer protocol is enabled
and no multiplexer control channel is established. The GSM engine re-
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 91 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
turns to the AT command mode.
3. There are various options to switch from data mode to command mode:
a) Escape sequence +++
b) Circuit 108/2 (DTR) changes from ON to OFF, reaction depends on
command at&d (caution if AT&D0: TA ignores status on DTR).
c) The message Modem Status Command (MSC) for control channel is
defined by the multiplexer protocol GSM07.10. MSC conveys V.24
signals. Bit 3 of Control Signal Octet is DTR, reaction depends on
command at&d (caution if AT&D0: TA ignores status on DTR).
4. The parameter maximum frame size (N1) of AT+CMUX in GSM07.07 is
fixed to 97 and cannot be changed. All other parameters are not available.
5. Multiplex mode can be terminated by AT^SMSO (,AT^SMSO Switch off
mobile station" pg. 191). It has to be reestablished after power-on.
4.28.1 Restricted use of AT commands in Multiplex mode
In Multiplex mode, the operation of several AT commands varies from the normal mode. This chapter
summarizes the concerned commands. For general rules and restrictions to be considered in Multiplex
mode please refer to [5].
Data, fax and GPRS calls can only be set up on logical channel 1. Due to this restriction, AT commands have a different behaviour on channels 2+3 compared to channel 1. Several commands are
not available, others return different responses. These commands are listed in the table below:
Table 6: Availability of AT commands on virtual channels
Command
+++
ATE
AT+CBST
AT+CR
AT+CRLP
AT+CG... (GPRS commands)
AT+F.... (Fax commands)
AT&C
AT&D
AT&F
Behaviour on channel 1
as described
as described
as described
as described
as described
as described
as described
as described
as described
as described
AT&S
AT&V
ATA
ATD
ATDI<n>
ATO
as described
as described
as described
as described
as described
as described
as described
Differences on channel 2+3
not usable
as described
not usable
not usable
not usable
2)
usage not recommended
not usable
not usable
not usable
data call parameters not changed
S3, S4 not changed
not usable
data call parameters not displayed
no data calls
no data calls
not usable
not usable
not usable
as described
as described
1
ATS0 )
1
ATS3 )
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 92 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Command
Behaviour on channel 1
as described
Differences on channel 2+3
as described
1
as described
not usable
1
as described
not usable
1
as described
not usable
ATS8 )
as described
not usable
1
as described
not usable
1
as described
not usable
as described
as described
not usable
data call parameters not changed
1
ATS4 )
ATS5 )
ATS6 )
ATS7 )
1
ATS10 )
ATS18 )
AT\Q
ATZ
1)
2)
Siemens GSM engines support the registers S0 - S29. You can change S0, S3, S4, S5, S6, S7,S8,
S10 and S18 using the related ATSn commands (see starting from pg. 26). The other registers are
read-only and for internal use only!
MC35 allows to use the GPRS commands on all logical channels, but to remain compatible to future releases it is recommended to use them on channel 1 only. PDP contexts can be defined on
any channel, but are visible and usable only on the channel on which they are defined (thus it is
not possible to define a context on channel 2 and activate it on channel 3). GPRS data calls can be
initiated on any channel but will be always established on channel 1.
Table 7: Summary of AT commands with different behaviour in Multiplex mode
Command
Description
Chapter
ATH
Terminates any call in progress, no matter what channel was used to
enter ATH
2.12
AT&V
Different default configurations on channels 1, 2 and 3
2.37
AT+IPR
Before you start Multiplex mode, it is recommended to set the ME to
57600 bps, especially if you want to use all the three channels. Once
it is activated, the bitrate on channels 2 + 3 should be set to 19200
bps.
2.45
AT+IPR=0
Autobauding is not compatible with Multiplex mode. It is neither possible to start MUX when autobauding is active, nor to set autobauding
during Multiplex mode.
2.45.1
AT+CALA
Alarm calls can be separately configured on each channel. The read
command returns the total number of alarm calls activated on all
channels.
4.2
AT+CMEE
Presentation mode can be separately configured for each channel.
4.26
AT+CNMA
If Multiplex mode is activated the +CNMI parameter will be set to zero
on all channels, if one channel fails to acknowledge an incoming
message within the required time.
5.9
AT+CNMI
Phase 2+ parameters can only be used on one channel. The parameter for <mt> and <ds> on the other channels have to be set to
zero.
5.10
If either a SM or a Status Report is not acknowledged, all +CNMI parameter will be set to zero on all channels.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 93 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.29 AT+COPN Read operator names
Test command
Response
AT+COPN=?
OK
Execute command
TA returns the list of operator names from the ME. Each operator code <numericn> that has an alphanumeric equivalent <alphan> in the ME memory is
returned.
AT+COPN
Response
+COPN: numeric <numeric1>,long alphanumeric <alpha1><CR><LF>
+COPN:.....OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<numericn>
<alphan>
string type; operator in numeric form; GSM location area identification number
string type; operator in long alphanumeric format; can contain
up to 16 characters
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
See also AT^SPLM, pg. 205
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 94 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.30 AT+COPS Operator selection
This command can be used to query the present status of the ME's network registration and to determine whether automatic or manual network selection shall be used.
Automatic mode:
Lets the ME automatically search for the home operator. If successful the ME
registers to the home network and enters the IDLE mode. If the home network
is not found, ME goes on searching. If then a permitted operator is found, ME
registers to this operator. If no operator is found the ME remains unregistered.
Manual mode:
Desired operator can be manually entered, using the AT+COPS write command syntax. If operator is found, ME registers to this operator. If the selected
operator is forbidden, the ME remains unregistered.
Manual/automatic: In this mode, the ME first tries to find the operator that was manually entered.
If the ME fails to register to this operator, then it starts to select automatically
another network.
Test command
AT+COPS=?
TA returns a list of quadruplets, each representing an operator present in the
network. The list of operators is presented in the following order: Home network, networks referenced in SIM, and other networks. Two commas in a
succession (,,) are a placeholder for the non-implemented <format>1 (short
alphanumeric operator name).
Response
+COPS: (list of supported (<stat>, long alphanumeric <oper>,, numeric
<oper>s) [,(list of supported <mode>s), (list of supported <format>s)] OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameters
<stat>
Read command
AT+COPS?
0
unknown
1
operator available
2
current operator (registered)
<oper>
3
forbidden operator
operator as per <format>
<mode>
0 - 4 see write command
<format>
0 - 2 see write command
TA returns the current mode and, if registered, the currently used operator. If
the ME is unregistered, <format> and <oper> are omitted.
Response
+COPS: <mode>[, <format>[, <oper>]] OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameters
See write command
Write command
AT+COPS=
<mode>
[,<format>[,<oper>]]
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
The write command allows you to choose whether the GSM network operator
is to be selected automatically or manually. When using the manual mode, the
<operator> must be entered, no matter whether you want to search for the
home operator or another one.
Page 95 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Response
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameters
<mode>
0
1
2
3
4
Reference
automatic mode; <oper> field is ignored
manual operator selection
<oper> field must be present, <format> can only be = 2
manually deregister from network and remain unregistered
until mode 0,1,4 is selected
set <format> for read command +COPS?
combination of manual/automatic mode;
if manual selection fails, ME switches to automatic mode
(<mode>=0). (<oper> field must be present)
<oper>
operator as per <format>
<format>
0
2
long format alphanumeric <oper>; up to 16 characters
numeric <oper>; GSM Location Area Identification number
Note
GSM 07.07
Example 1
Example 2
To query the present status of ME's network registration using the test command:
AT+COPS=?
+COPS:
(2,"D2",,"26202"),(3,"E-Plus",,"26203"),(3,"TD1",,"26201"),(3,"Interkom",,"26207"),,(0-4),(0,2)
OK
Registered operator is D2. The other operators are present in the network, but
not allowed to be used with the current SIM card.
To query the status of the ME's network registration using the read command:
AT+COPS?
+COPS: 0,0,"D2" (command returns mode, format, registered operator)
OK
Attempt to manually select a forbidden operator:
AT+COPS=1,2,26203
OK
If the selected operator was not allowed, the ME is now unregistered. The
read command will return only the mode, but no operator:
AT+COPS?
+COPS: 1
In this case, the test command returns only that the desired operator is available (<stat=1). Nevertheless, the registration is not successful. Please use the
AT+CREG command (Chapter 4.41) to verify the registration status.
AT+COPS=?
+COPS:
(1,"D2",,"26202"),(3,"E-Plus",,"26203"),(3,"TD1",,"26201"),(3,"Interkom",,"26207"),,(0-4),(0,2)
OK
AT+CREG?
+CREG: 0,3
(where 3 = registration denied)
OK
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 96 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.31 AT+CPAS Mobile equipment activity status
Test command
Response
AT+CPAS=?
+CPAS: (list of supported <pas>s) OK
Parameter
See execute command
Execute command
Response
AT+CPAS
TA returns the activity status of ME.
+CPAS: <pas> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<pas>
0 ready
3 incoming call (ringing)
4 call in progress or call hold
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 97 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.32 AT+CPBR Read current phonebook entries
Test command
Response
AT+CPBR=?
TA returns location range supported by the current storage as a compound value
and the maximum length of <number> and <text> fields.
Note:
If SIM storage is selected, the length may not be available. If storage does not
offer format information, the format list should be empty parentheses.
+CPBR: (list of supported <index>s), <nlength>, <tlength> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<index>
supported range of location numbers (maximum number depends on storage type)
<nlength>
max. length of phone number, normally 20, for a small number of locations 40
<tlength>
max. length of text assigned to phone number (depending on
storage type 16 - 18 characters including blanks)
Execute command
Response
AT+CPBR=<ind
ex1>[,<index2>]
TA returns phonebook entries in location number range <index1> ... <index2>
from the current phonebook memory storage selected with +CPBS. If <index2> is
left out, only location <index1> is returned.
+CPBR: <index1>, <number>, <type>, <text>[<CR><LF>+CPBR: .....+CPBR: <index2>, <number>, <type>, <text>] OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR
Parameter
location number where reading starts
location number where reading ends
phone number
type of address octet in integer format; 145 when dialling string
includes international access code character “+”, otherwise 129.
<text>
string type field of maximum length <tlength>. Character set as
specified with +CSCS.
1. First, run the Test command to find out the maximum range of entries stored
in the active phonebook:
AT+CPBR=?
TA returns the supported values in the format: +CPBR: (1-100),20,17 where
100 is the supported range of location numbers, 20 is the length of the phone
number and 17 is the maximum length of the text associated text.
<index1>
<index2>
<number>
<type>
Example
2. Now, run the Execute command to display the phonebook entries sorted by
location numbers.
AT+CPBR =1,100
+CPBR 1,"+999999",145,"Charlie"
+CPBR: 2,"+777777",145,"Bill"
+CPBR: 3,"+888888",145,"Arthur" .........
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 98 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.33 AT+CPBS Select phonebook memory storage
Test command
Response
AT+CPBS=?
+CPBS: (list of supported <storage>s) OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CPBS?
TA returns currently selected memory:
+CPBS: <storage>,<used>,<total> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+CPBS=
<storage>
TA selects current phonebook memory storage, which is used by other phonebook commands.
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<storage>
“SM” SIM phonebook (storage depends on SIM Card)
“FD” SIM fixdialling phonebook (FD Phonebook storage pos.1-7).
If the mobile is locked to FD, only the numbers stored to the
FD memory can be dialled. To edit the FD phonebook PIN 2
is required. See AT+CLCK Facility lock and AT^SLCK Facility lock.
“LD” SIM last-dialling-phonebook (LD Phonebook storage pos.110) (+CPBW not be applicable to this storage)
“MC” ME missed (unanswered received) calls) (MC Phonebook
storage pos.1-10) list (+CPBW not applicable to this storage
“RC” ME received calls list (+CPBW not applicable for this storage) (RC Phonebook storage pos.1-10)
“ON” SIM (or ME) own numbers (MSISDNs) list
“ME” ME Phonebook (storage pos.1-50)
<used>
Integer type value indicating the number of used locations in selected memory
<total>
Integer type value indicating the maximum number of locations allowed in the selected memory
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
This command can be used right after power-on to get selected <storage>.
Since data need to be loaded from the SIM, values of <used> and <total> might
not be available for the first 20 seconds.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 99 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.34 AT+CPBW Write phonebook entry
Test command
Response
AT+CPBW=?
TA returns location range supported by the current storage, the maximum
length of <number> field, supported number formats of the storage and the
maximum length of <text> field.
Note: The length may not be available while SIM storage is selected. If storage
does not offer format information, the format list should be empty parenthesises.
+CPBW: (list of supported <index>s), <nlength>, (list of supported <type>s),
<tlength> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
Write command
AT+CPBW=
[<index>]
[,<number>
[[,<type>]
[,<text>]]]
See write command.
This command writes a phonebook entry to the memory location <index> of the
active memory.
The memory location number <index> is followed by the phone number <number> (in the format <type>) and the associated <text>.
If writing fails, an ME error +CME ERROR: <err> is returned.
Parameter
<index>
<number>
<type>
<text>
<nlength>
<tlength>
Location number within phonebook memory, total range is given
in test command response
Phone number, maximum length is given as <nlength> in test
command response
Type of phone number (address octet in integer format); 145 when
dialling string includes international access code character “+”,
otherwise 129 (refer GSM 04.08 subclause 10.5.4.7)
Text assigned to the phone number, maximum length is given in
test command response <tlength>. Character set as specified with
+CSCS. See note below.
Max. length of phone number, normally 20, for a small number of
locations 40
Max. length of text assigned to phone number (depending on
storage type 16 - 18 characters including blanks)
Response
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
To delete a phonebook entry simply enter the location number:
AT+CPBW=<index>
To write a phonebook entry to the first free location number:
AT+CPBW=,<number>,<type>,<text>
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
If <text> contains characters which are coded differently in ASCII and GSM
(e.g. Ä, Ö, Ü), these characters have to be entered via escape sequences as
described in chapter “Supported character sets“, pg. 12.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 100 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.35 AT+CPIN Enter PIN
Test command
Response
AT+CPIN=?
OK
Read command
Response
AT+CPIN?
TA returns an alphanumeric string indicating whether or not a password is required.
+CPIN: <code> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<code>
SIM PIN authentication
READY
PIN has already been entered. No further entry
needed.
SIM PIN
ME is waiting for SIM PIN1.
SIM PUK
ME is waiting for SIM PUK1 if PIN1 was disabled after three failed attempts to enter PIN1.
SIM PIN2
ME is waiting for PIN2, when the attempt to access PIN2 requiring features was acknowledged
with +CME ERROR:17 (e.g. if client attempts to
edit the FD phonebook).
SIM PUK2
ME is waiting for PUK2 to unblock a disabled
PIN2. Necessary if preceding command was acknowledged with error +CME ERROR:18.
Phone security locks set by client or factory
PH-SIM PIN
ME is waiting for phone-to-SIM card password if
"PS" lock is active and user inserts other SIM
card than the one used for the lock. ("PS" lock is
also referred to as phone or antitheft lock).
PH-SIM PUK
ME is waiting for Master Phone Code, if the
above "PS" lock password was incorrectly entered three times.
Factory set SIM locks
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
PH-FSIM PIN
ME is waiting for phone-to-very-first-SIM card.
Necessary when "PF" lock was set. When powered up the first time, ME locks itself to the first
SIM card put into the card holder. As a result,
operation of the mobile is restricted to this one
SIM card (unless the PH-FSIM PUK is used as
described below).
PH-FSIM PUK
ME is waiting for phone-to-very-first-SIM card
unblocking password to be given. Necessary
when "PF" lock is active and other than first SIM
card is inserted.
Page 101 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
PH-NET PIN
ME is waiting for network personalisation password
PH-NET PUK
ME is waiting for network personalisation unblocking password
PH-NS PIN
ME is waiting for network subset personalisation
password
PH-NS PUK
ME is waiting for network subset unblocking
password
PH-SP PIN
ME is waiting for service provider personalisation password
PH-SP PUK
ME is waiting for service provider personalisation unblocking password
PH-C PIN
ME is waiting for corporate personalisation
password
PH-C PUK
ME is waiting for corprorate personalisation unblocking password
See Chapters 4.21 and 8.13 for information on lock types.
Write command
Response
AT+CPIN=<pin>
[,<new pin>]
The write command lets the ME store the entered password. This may be for
example the SIM PIN1 to register to the GSM network, or the SIM PUK1 to replace a disabled PIN with a new one, or the PH-SIM PIN if the client has taken
precautions for preventing damage in the event of loss or theft etc. See above
for the list of passwords.
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
If no PIN request is pending (for example if PIN authentication has been done
and the same PIN is entered again) ME responds +CME ERROR: operation not
allowed. No action is required from your part.
Parameter
<pin>
password (string type), usually SIM PIN1.
If the requested password was a PUK, such as SIM PUK1 or PHSIM PUK or PH-FSIM PUK or another password, then <pin> must
be followed by <newpin>.
<new pin>
if the requested code was a PUK: specify a new password or restore the former disabled password. See Chapter 4.35.1 for more
information about when you may need to enter the PUK.
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
• Caution: After entering a password with AT+CPIN all other commands that
need access to data on the SIM card may be blocked for up to 20 seconds!
• Successful PIN authentication only confirms that the entered PIN was recognized and correct. The output of the result code OK does not necessarily
imply that the mobile is registered to the desired network.
Typical example: PIN was entered and accepted with OK, but the ME fails
to register to the network. This may due to missing network coverage, denied network access with currently used SIM card, no valid roaming agreement between home network and currently available operators etc.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 102 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
•
•
•
•
•
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
MC35 offers various options to verify the present status of network registration: For example, the AT+COPS? (Chapter 4.30) command indicates the
currently used network. With AT+CREG (Chapter 4.41) you can also check
the current status and activate an unsolicited result code which appears
whenever the status of the network registration changes (e.g. when the ME
is powered up, or when the network cell changes).
Wait 10 seconds after PIN input before using SMS related commands.
<pin> and <new pin> can also be entered in quotation marks (e.g. ”1234”).
To check the number of remaining to attempts to enter the passwords use
the AT^SPIC command. See Chapter 8.31.
See also Chapter 9.2 “Summary of PIN requiring AT Commands“.
See Chapters 4.38 and 8.35 for information on passwords.
Page 103 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.35.1 What to do if PIN or password authentication fails?
PIN1 / PUK1:
After three failures to enter PIN 1, the SIM card is blocked (except for emergency
calls). To unblock the SIM card, the client needs to enter the associated PUK (= PIN
Unblocking Key / Personal Unblocking Key). After ten failed attempts to enter the
PUK, the SIM card will be invalidated and no longer operable. In such a case, the card
needs to be replaced.
To unblock a disabled PIN1, use the AT+CPIN command and enter the PUK when
prompted by the response +CME ERROR: 12. Alternatively, you can use the ATD
command followed by the GSM code **05*PUK*newPIN*newPIN#.
PIN2 / PUK2:
PIN2 prevents unauthorized access to the features listed in Chapter 4.36. The handling of PIN2 varies with the provider. PIN2 may either be a specific code supplied
along with an associated PUK2, or a default code such as 0000. In either case, the
client is advised to replace it with an individual code. Incorrect input of PUK2 will permanently block the additional features subject to PIN2 authentification, but usually has
no affect on PIN1.
To unblock a disabled PIN2, use the AT+CPIN command and enter the PUK2 when
prompted by the response +CPIN: SIM PUK2 or after the equivalent error code: +CME
ERROR: 18 was returned. Alternatively, you can use the ATD command followed by
the GSM code **052*PUK*newPIN*newPIN#.
Phone lock:
If the mobile was locked to a specific SIM card (= "PS" lock or phone lock), the PUK
that came with the SIM card cannot be used to remove the lock. After three failed attempts to enter the correct password, ME returns +CPIN: PH-SIM PUK (= response to
read command AT+CPIN?), i.e. it is now waiting for the Master Phone Code. This is
an 8-digit device code associated to the IMEI number of the mobile which can only by
obtained from the manufacturer or provider. When needed, contact Siemens AG and
request the Master Phone Code of the specific module.
Please note that, in contrast to Siemens mobile phones, the GSM engines do not support the option of sending the Master Phone Code with ATD and a *#0003*<number>#
GSM code. Therefore, enter the Master Phone Code when prompted after input of
AT+CPIN. For instructions see the examples provided in Chapter 4.21.2).
As an alternative, you can use the AT+CPWD command and specify a new password
for <fac>="PS". To do so, enter the Master Phone Code for <oldpwd> followed by
<newpwd>, where <newpwd> may be the former disabled "PS" password or a new
one (see examples in Chapters 4.21.2 and 4.38).
Usually, the Master Phone Code will be supplied by mail or e-mail. If the received
number is enclosed in the *# codes typically used for mobile phones, it is important to
crop the preceding *#0003* characters and the appended #.
Example: You may be given the string *#0003*12345678#. When prompted
for the PH-SIM PUK simply enter 12345678.
If incorrectly input, the Master Phone Code is governed by a specific timing algorithm:
(n-1)*256 seconds (see table below). The timing should be considered by system integrators when designing an individual MMI.
Table 8: Timing algorithm of incorrect password input
Number of failed attempts
st
1 failed attempt
nd
2 failed attempt
rd
3 failed attempt
th
4 failed attempt
th
5 failed attempt
th
6 failed attempt and so forth
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Time to wait before next input is allowed
No time to wait
4 seconds
3 * 256 seconds
4 * 256 seconds
5 * 256 seconds
6 * 256 seconds and so forth
Page 104 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
SIM locks:
These are factory set locks, such as "PF", "PN", "PU", "PP", "PC". An 8-digit unlocking
code is required to operate the mobile with a different SIM card, or to lift the lock. The
code can only be obtained from the provider.
Failure to enter the password is subject to the same timing algorithm as the Master
Phone Code (see Table 8).
Call barring:
Supported modes are "AO", "OI", "OX", "AI", "IR", "AB", "AG", "AC". If the call barring
password is entered incorrectly three times, the client will need to contact the service
provider to obtain a new one.
Summary of related chapters:
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Related +CME errors are listed in Chapter 9.1.1. For further instructions and examples see Chapters 4.21 (AT+CLCK Facility lock), 8.13
(AT^SLCK Facility lock, 4.38 (AT+CPWD Change password) and
8.35 (AT^SPWD Change password for a lock. A complete list of **#
codes is provided in Chapter 9.4.
Page 105 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.36 AT+CPIN2 Enter PIN2
Test command
Response
AT+CPIN2=?
OK
Read command
Response
AT+CPIN2?
TA returns an alphanumeric string indicating whether some password is required
or not.
+CPIN2: <code> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<code>
READY
ME is not pending for any password
SIM PIN2
ME is waiting for SIM PIN2.
This <code> is returned only when PIN2 authentication has not yet been done or has failed (+CME
ERROR:17).
SIM PUK2
ME is waiting for SIM PUK2.
This <code> is returned only when PIN2 authentication has failed and ME is pending for SIM PUK2
(i.e. +CME ERROR:18).
Write command
Response
AT+CPIN2=
<pin>[,<new
pin>]
The write command lets the ME store the entered password. This may be for example the SIM PIN2 to benefit from the features listed below, or the SIM PUK2 to
replace a disabled PIN2 with a new one. Note that PIN2 can only be entered if
PIN1 authentication was done.
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
If the ME is requesting SIM PUK2, use <pin> to enter the PUK2, followed by
<newpin> to specify your new PIN2.
Parameter
Reference
<pin>
password (string type), usually SIM PIN2 or, if requested, SIM PUK2
<new pin>
if the requested code was SIM PUK2: new password (PIN2.
See Chapter 4.35.1 for more information about when you may need
to enter the PUK.
Note
Functions accessible only after PIN2 authentication:
• AT+CACM: Accumulated call meter (ACM) reset or query
• AT+CAMM: Accumulated call meter maximum (ACMmax) set or query
• AT+CLCK: Facility lock to "FD" (Fixed dialling phonebook)
• AT^SLCK: Facility lock to "FD" (Fixed dialling phonebook)
• AT+CPWD: Change "P2"password
• AT^SPWD: Change "P2"password
• AT+CPUC: Price per unit and currency table
• AT+CPIN2: Enter SIM PIN2 or SIM PUK2 if requested.
For example, SIM PIN2 will be needed when you attempt to edit the "FD"
phonebook and ME returns +CME Error 17 or +CPIN: SIM PIN2.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 106 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Note that the PIN2 authentication remains active for 300s. This means, for example, that PIN2 will be requested once again, when you try to edit the "FD" phonebook later than 300s after PIN2 authentication has been done.
Example 1
Example 2
To change PIN2:
AT+CPWD=P2,0000,8888
(where 0000 = old PIN2 and 8888 = new PIN2)
To write to "FD" phonebook:
AT+CBPS="FD"
OK
AT+CPBW=2,"+493012345678",145,"Charly"
+CME Error 17 (access denied due to missing PIN2 authentication)
AT+CPIN2=8888
OK
AT+CPBW=2,"+493012345678",145,"Charly"
OK
Example 3
To change price per unit:
AT+CPUC="dm","5",8888
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 107 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.37 AT+CPUC Price per unit and currency table
Test command
Response
AT+CPUC=?
OK
Read command
Response
AT+CPUC?
Read command returns the current parameters of PUC.
+CPUC: <currency>, <ppu> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+CPUC=<curre
ncy>,<ppu>[,
<passwd>]
Write command sets the parameters of Advice of Charge related price per unit
and currency table. SIM PIN2 is usually required to set the parameters.
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<currency>
string type; three-character currency code (e.g. “GBP”, “DEM”);
character set as specified with AT+CSCS. If the currency name
is longer than three characters, all characters will be cut off after
the third position. Before they are written to the SIM Card, these
characters are converted to the standard GSM alphabet.
<ppu>
string type; price per unit; dot is used as a decimal separator
(e.g. “2.66”). The length is limited to 20 characters. If the string
length is exceeded, the command is terminated with an error.
This string may only contain digits and a dot. Leading zeros are
removed from the string. The minimum and maximum value are
determined by the structure of the SIM-PUCT file. The maximum
price per unit value is 999 999 999.00. When successfully entered, this value is rounded to maximum accuracy.
Due to storage in mantisse (range 0-4095) and exponent (-7
to 7) it is possible that rounding errors occur.
Note:
<passwd>
Reference
string type; SIM PIN2. String parameter which can contain any
combination of characters. The maximum string length is limited
to 8 characters. If this value is exceeded, the command terminates with an error message. If the PIN2 is incorrect, a CME error (+CME ERROR: incorrect password) is output.
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 108 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.38 AT+CPWD Change password
Use this command when you want to
• change PIN1 or PIN2
• change the password supplied from your provider for call barring
• set individual phone security passwords
See Chapters 4.21 and 8.13 for more information on the various lock features. The AT^SPWD
command is a Siemens defined command equivalent to AT+CPWD. See Chapter 8.35.
Test command
Response
AT+CPWD=?
TA returns a list of pairs which represent the available facilities and the maximum length of the associated password.
+CPWD: (list of supported (<fac>, <pwdlength>)s) OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<fac>
see execute command
<pwdlength> integer max. length of password
Execute command
Response
AT+CPWD =
TA sets a new password for the facility lock function.
<fac>, [<oldpwd>], OK
<newpwd>
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<fac> Phone security locks set by manufacturer or client:
"SC" SIM (lock SIM card). SIM asks SIM PIN1 when ME is switched
on and when this lock command is issued.
"P2" SIM PIN2. Used to access the functions listed in Chapter 4.36.
"PS" Phone locked to SIM (device code). The "PS" password may either be individually specified by the client or, depending on the
subscription, supplied from the provider (e.g. with a prepaid mobile).
Note:
Each, SIM PIN1 and SIM PIN2 are assigned a PUK to unblock a
disabled PIN.
The "PS" password, however, is never associated with a PUK. If
it is incorrectly entered three times, the Master Phone Code is
required. See Chapter 4.35.1
Locks set by the manufacturer:
"PF" lock Phone to the very first SIM card
"PN" Network Personalisation
"PU" Network-subset Personalisation
"PP" Service-Provider Personalisation
"PC" Corporate Personalisation
Note:
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Typical examples of factory set locks are prepaid phones or network locks (e.g. if the operation of a mobile is restricted to a specific provider or operator). The locks can only be set by the
manufacturer and need to be agreed upon between the parties
Page 109 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
concerned, e.g. provider, operator, distributor etc. on the one
side and the manufacturer on the other side. For details contact
your local dealer or Siemens AG.
The client should be aware that each of these lock types can
only be unlocked if the associated password is available. See
Chapter 4.35 and 4.35.1 for further instructions.
Supplementary Service: Call barring
"AO" BAOC (Bar All Outgoing Calls)
"OI" BOIC ( Bar Outgoing International Calls)
"OX" BOIC-exHC ( Bar Outgoing International Calls except to Home
Country)
"AI" BAIC (Bar All Incoming Calls)
"IR" BIC-Roam (Bar Incoming Calls when Roaming outside the home
country)
"AB" All Barring services (applicable only for <mode> = 0)
"AG" All outGoing barring services (applicable only for <mode> = 0)
"AC" All inComing barring services (applicable only for <mode> = 0)
Note:
The availability of the Supplementary Services varies with the
network. To benefit from call barring the client will need to subscribe them, though a limited number of call barring types may
be included in the basic tariff package. Call barring is protected
by a password supplied from the provider or operator. Usually
there is one password which applies to all call barring options.
For details contact your provider.
<oldpwd>
password specified for the facility.
Can be ignored if no old password was allocated to the facility.
Take into account that a password may have already been set
by factory, or that the service is subject to a password issued by
the provider. See notes above or contact provider.
if <fac> = “SC” then PIN
if <fac> = “AO”...”AC” (barring) then network password
(if needed)
if <fac> = “P2” then PIN2
if <fac> = “PS” then password
<newpwd>
new password
To delete a password use the following syntax:
at+cpwd=<fac>,<oldpwd>
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
CAUTION: After three attempts to enter a false PIN you will be prompted to
enter the PUK. Failure to enter the PUK will permanently diasble the SIM card.
See Chapter 4.35.1 for more information.
Example 1
To change PIN2:
AT+CPWD=P2,0000,8888
Example 2
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
(where 0000 = old PIN2 and 8888 = new PIN2)
To set password used to enable or disable barring of all outgoing calls:
AT+CPWD=ao,0000,3333
Page 110 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Example 3
To change the "PS" lock password, using the correct old password:
AT+CPWD=PS,1111,2222
(where 1111 = old "PS" password and 2222 =
new password)
To specify a new "PS" lock password, after the old password was disabled, e.g.
after three failed attempts to enter the password (only if Master Phone Code is
availbale):
AT+CPWD=PS,12345678,1111 (where 12345678 is the Master Phone code
and 1111 is the new password. You may also
use <newpwd> to restore the former disabled
password). This operation deactivates the
present phone lock and sets a new one. See
also Chapter 4.35.1.
Alternatively, whithout giving a new password:
AT+CPWD=PS,12345678
Deactivates the present phone lock.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 111 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.39 AT+CR Service reporting control
Test command
Response
AT+CR=?
+CR: (list of supported <mode>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CR?
+CR: <mode> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+CR=<mode>
Configures the TA whether or not to transmit an intermediate result code +CR:
<serv> to TE when a call is being set up.
OK
Parameter
<mode> 0 disable
1 enable
Intermediate result code
If enabled, an intermediate result code is transmitted at the point during connect negotiation when the TA has determined the speed and quality of service
to be used, before any error control or data compression reports are transmitted, and before any final result code (e.g. CONNECT) appears.
+CR:<serv>
Parameter
<serv>
REL ASYNC
asynchronous non-transparent
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
The PLMN influences the second air interface (to the terminator), therefore another mode may be established from the network
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 112 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.40 AT+CRC Set Cellular Result Codes for incoming call indication
Test command
Response
AT+CRC=?
+CRC: (list of supported <mode>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CRC?
+CRC: <mode> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+CRC=
[<mode>]
Specifies whether or not to use the extended format of incoming call indication.
OK
Parameters
<mode> 0 disable extended format
1 enable extended format
Unsolicited result code
If enabled, the unsolicited result code +CRING: <type> replaces the normal
RING code to indicate the incoming call and the type of the call.
Parameter
<type>
Reference
REL ASYNC
asynchronous non-transparent
FAX
facsimile
VOICE
voice
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 113 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.41 AT+CREG Network registration
Test command
Response
AT+CREG=?
+CREG: (list of supported <n>s) OK
Parameter
Read command
AT+CREG?
See write command
ME returns the URC presentation mode <n> and an integer <stat> that shows
the registration status of the ME. The location information elements <lac> and
<ci> are returned only when <n>=2 and ME is registered to the network.
Response
+CREG: <n>,<stat>[,<lac>,<ci>]
OK
or if an error occurs which is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err> (for error text see Chapter 9.1.1. or set AT+CMEE=2)
Write command
AT+CREG=
[<n>]
Use the write command to select the type of URC. Two types of URCs are
available:
+CREG: <stat> if <n>=1. To be issued when the ME's network registration
status changes
or
+CREG: <stat>[,<lac>,<ci>] if <n>=2. To be issued when ME's network registration or network cell changes.
Response
OK
or if an error occurs which is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
<err>
256
If <n> = 0: Attempt to set once again <n>=0 causes error
code 256.
If <n> > 0: Attempt to activate a URC mode that is already
active is acknowledged with OK.
0
disable URCs
1
enable URC +CREG:<stat> to report status of network registration
2
enable URC +CREG:<stat>[,<lac>,<ci>] to report status of
network registration including location information. Please
note that optional parameters will not be displayed during
call.
0
not registered, ME is currently not searching for new operator
1
registered, home network
2
not registered, but ME is currently searching for a new operator
3
registration denied
4
unknown
5
registered, roaming
Parameter
<n >
<stat>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
<lac>
string type; two byte location area code in hexadecimal format
(e.g. "00C3" equals 193 in decimal)
<ci>
string type; two byte cell ID in hexadecimal format
Page 114 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Unsolicited result code
If <n>=1 and there is a change in the ME network registration status:
+CREG: <stat>
If <n>=2 and there is a change in the ME network registration status or a
change of the network cell:
+CREG: <stat>[,<lac>,<ci>]
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
Optional parameters will not be displayed during a call.
Example
AT+CREG=2
OK
Activates extended URC mode.
AT+COPS=0
OK
Forces ME to automatically search network
operator.
+CREG: 2
+CREG: 1,"0145","291A"
URC reports that ME is currently searching.
URC reports that operator has been found.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 115 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.42 AT+CRLP Select radio link protocol param. for orig. non-transparent
data call
Test command
Response
AT+CRLP=?
TA returns values supported by the TA as a compound value.
+CRLP: (list of supported <iws>s), (list of supported <mws>s), (list of supported
<T1>s), (list of supported <N2>s)
OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CRLP?
TA returns current settings for the supported RLP version 0.
+CRLP: <iws>,<mws>,<T1>,<N2>[,<verx>]
OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+CRLP= [<iws> TA sets radio link protocol (RLP) parameters used when non-transparent data
[,<mws> [,<T1>
calls are originated.
[,<N2 >]]]]
OK
Parameter
<iws>
0-61
Interworking window size (IWF to MS)
<mws>
0-61
Mobile window size (MS to IWF)
<T1>
48-78-255
Acknowledgement timer (T1 in 10 ms units)
<N2>
1-6-255
Re-transmission attempts N2
<verx>
0
RLP version number in integer format; when version
indication is not present it shall equal 0.
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
• RLP version 0: single-link basic version;
• RLP version 1: single-link extended version (e.g. extended by data compression);
• RLP version 2: multi-link version.
• Compression and multi-link are not supported.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 116 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.43 AT+CRSM Restricted SIM access
Test command
Response
AT+CRSM=?
OK
Write command
By using this command the TE has access to the SIM database. SIM access is
restricted to the commands which are listed below.
As response to the command the ME sends the current SIM information parameters and response data. ME error result code +CME ERROR may be returned when the command cannot be passed to the SIM, but failure in the execution of the command in the SIM is reported in <sw1> and <sw2> parameters.
AT+CRSM=<com
mand>[,<fileId>
[,<P1>,<P2>,<P3>
[,<data>]]]
Response
+CRSM: <sw1>, <sw2> [,<response>]
OK / ERROR / +CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<command>
176
READ BINARY
178
READ RECORD
192
GET RESPONSE
214
UPDATE BINARY
220
UPDATE RECORD
242
STATUS
all other values are reserved; refer GSM 11.11.
Reference
<fileId>
integer type; this is the identifier for an elementary
data file on SIM. Mandatory for every command except STATUS
<P1>,<P2>,<P3>
integer type, range 0 - 255
parameters to be passed on by the ME to the SIM;
refer GSM 11.11.
<data>
information which shall be written to the SIM (hexadecimal character format)
<sw1>, <sw2>
integer type, range 0 - 255
status information from the SIM about the execution
of the actual command. These parameters are delivered to the TE in both cases, on successful or failed
execution of the command; refer GSM 11.11.
<response>
response of a successful completion of the command
previously issued (hexadecimal character format)
Note
GSM 07.07
GSM 11.11
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 117 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.44 AT+CSCS Set TE character set
Test command
Response
AT+CSCS=?
+CSCS: (list of supported <chset>s)
OK
Read command
Response
AT+CSCS?
+CSCS: <chset>
OK
Write command
Response
AT+CSCS=[<chset>]
Write command informs TA which character set <chset> is used by the TE.
TA is then able to convert character strings correctly between TE and ME
character sets.
OK
Parameters
<chset>:
"GSM" GSM default alphabet (GSM 03.38 subclause 6.2.1);
Note: This setting may cause software flow control problems due
to values of XON/XOFF characters.
"UCS2" 16-bit universal multiple-octet coded character set (ISO/IEC10646
[32]); UCS2 character strings are converted to hexadecimal numbers from 0000 to FFFF; e.g. "004100620063" equals three 16-bit
characters with decimal values 65, 98 and 99, $(AT R97)$
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
• Also see chapter “Supported character sets“, pg. 12.
• When TA-TE interface is set to 8-bit operation and used TE alphabet is
7-bit, the highest bit will be set to zero.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 118 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.45 AT+CSNS Single Numbering Scheme
The AT+CSNS command enables the ME to accept incoming calls when no bearer capability information is provided with the call, e.g. single numbering scheme calls or calls originitating from analog
devices.
The command must be set before the call comes. By default, when you do not modify the settings,
all calls received without bearer element are assumed to be voice.
Please note that you can use the command if PIN authentication has been done during current session. The setting will be automatically saved when you power down the GSM engine with AT^SMSO.
Test command
Response
AT+CSNS=?
+CSNS: (list of supported <mode>s)
OK
Read command
Response
AT+CSNS?
+CSNS: <mode>
OK
Write command
Response
AT+CSNS=[<mode>]
Write command
OK
Parameters
<mode>:
Reference
0
Voice
Each call received without bearer element is assumed to be speech.
2
Fax
Each call received without bearer element is assumed to be an incoming fax.
4
Data
Each call received without bearer element is assumed to be a data call.
Please take into account that the bearer service
parameters set with AT+CBST apply to all data
calls including those received without bearer capability. To avoid conflicts see Chapter 4.5.
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 119 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.46 AT+CSQ Signal quality
Test command
Response
AT+CSQ=?
+CSQ: (list of supported <rssi>s), (list of supported <ber>) OK
Parameter
See execute command
Execute command
Response
AT+CSQ
TA returns received signal strength indication <rssi> and channel bit error rate
<ber> from the ME.
+CSQ: <rssi>, <ber> OK
Parameter
<rssi>
<ber>
Receive level:
0
-113 dBm or less
1
-111 dBm
2...30
-109... -53 dBm
31
-51 dBm or greater
99
not known or not detectable
Bit error rate:
0...7
as RXQUAL values in the table in GSM 05.08
section 8.2.4.
99
not known or not detectable.
To check the bit error rate there must be a call in progress to
obtain realistic values. If no call is set up, there is no BER to be
determined. In this case the indicated value may be 0 or 99,
depending on the SIM card.
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 120 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.47 AT+CSSN Supplementary service notifications
Test command
Response
AT+CSSN=?
+CSSN: (list of supported <n>s), (list of supported <m>s)OK
Parameter
<n>
<m>
0
Suppresses the +CSSI messages
1
Activates the +CSSI messages
0
Suppresses the +CSSU messages
1
Activates the +CSSU messages
Read command
Response
AT+CSSN?
+CSSN: <n>,<m>OK
Parameter
Write command
<n>
See Test command
<m>
See Test command
Response
AT+CSSN=<n>[,<m>] OK
Parameter
<n>
See read command
<m>
See read command
Unexpected message
+CSSI: <code1>
When <n>=1 and a supplementary service notification is
received after a mobile originated call setup, intermediate
result code +CSSI: <code1> is sent to TE before any
other MO call setup result codes
+CSSU: <code2>
When <m>=1 and a supplementary service notification is
received during a mobile terminated call setup or during
a call, unsolicited result code +CSSU: code2>is sent to
TE.
Parameter
<code1>
Intermediate result code
3
<code2>
Reference
Waiting call is pending
Unsolicited result code
0
The incoming call is a forwarded call.
5
Held call was terminated
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 121 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.48 AT+CUSD Unstructured supplementary service data
Test command
Response
AT+CUSD=?
+CUSD: (list of supported <n>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+ CUSD?
TA returns the current <n> value.
+CUSD: <n> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Write command
AT+ CUSD=
<n>[,<str>[,<dcs>]]
This command allows control of the Unstructured Supplementary Service
Data (USSD) according to GSM 02.90. Both network and mobile initiated operations are supported. Parameter <n> is used to disable/enable the presentation of an unsolicited result code (USSD response from the network, or network initiated operation) +CUSD:<m>[,<str>,<dcs>] to the TE.
When <str> is given, a mobile initiated USSD string or a response USSD
string to a network initiated operation is sent to the network. The response
USSD string from the network is returned in a subsequent unsolicited +CUSD
result code.
The interaction of this command with other commands based on other GSM
supplementary services is described in the GSM standard.
Parameter
<n>
<str>
0
disable the result code presentation in the TA
1
enable the result code presentation in the TA
2
cancel session (not applicable to read command response)
string type USSD-string (when <str> parameter is not given, network is not interrogated).
If <dcs> indicates that GSM 03.38 default alphabet is used
ME/TA converts GSM alphabet into current TE character set according to rules of GSM 07.05 Annex A.
<dcs>
GSM 03.38 Cell Broadcast Data Coding Scheme in integer format (default 15)
<m>
0
no further user action required (network initiated USSDNotify, or no further information needed after mobile initiated operation)
1
further user action required (network initiated USSDRequest, or further information needed after mobile initiated operation)
2
USSD terminated by network
Response
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
• For the write command <dcs>=15 is supported only.
• On an unsolicited result code with parameter <m>=1 a '> ' is given for further user action. The user action is finished with a <ctrl-Z> or aborted with
<ESC>.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 122 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.49 AT+VTD=<n> Tone duration
Test command
AT+VTD=?
This command refers to an integer <duration> that defines the length of tones
emitted as a result of the +VTS command.
Response
+VTD (list of supported <duration>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+VTD?
<duration> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+VTD=
<duration>
OK
Parameter
<duration>
1 – 255
Reference
duration of the tone in 1/10 second
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 123 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.50 AT+VTS DTMF and tone generation (<Tone> in {0-9, *, #, A, B, C, D})
Test command
Response
AT+VTS=?
+VTS: (list of supported <dtmf>s)[, (list of supported <duration>s)] OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
1.
AT+VTS=<dtmfstring>
This command allows the transmission of DTMF tones and arbitrary tones in
voice mode. These tones may be used (for example) when announcing the
start of a recording period.
• This is interpreted as a sequence of DTMF tones whose duration is set
with the +VTD command.
• This is interpreted as a DTMF tone whose duration is determined by <duration>.
OK
2.
AT+VTS=<dtmf>,<duration>
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<dtmfstring> String of ASCII characters in the set 0-9,#,*,A, B, C, D. Maximal
length of the string is 29. The string has to be entered between
double-quote characters (””).
<dtmf>
ASCII character in the set 0-9,#,*, A, B, C, D.
<duration>
1-255 duration of a tone in 1/10 second
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
This command only works during active voice call
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 124 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
4.51 AT+WS46 Select wireless network
Test command
Response
AT+WS46=?
(list of supported <n>s)
OK
Read command
Response
AT+WS46?
<n>
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<n>
12
GSM digital cellular
Write command
Response
AT+WS46=[<n>]
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 125 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5 AT commands originating from GSM 07.05 for SMS
The SMS related AT Commands are according to the GSM 07.05 specification issued by ETSI (European Telecommunications Standards Institute).
5.1
AT+CMGC Send an SMS command
Test command
Response
AT+CMGC=?
OK
Write command
Response
if text mode (AT+CMGF=1):
if text mode (+CMGF=1) and sending successful:
AT+CMGC=<fo>,<ct>[,<pid> +CMGC: <mr>[,<scts>]
[,<mn>[,<da>[,<toda>]]]]<CR> if sending fails:
text is entered <ctrl-Z/ESC>
+CMS ERROR: <err>
Write command
Response
if PDU mode (AT+CMGF=0):
AT+CMGC=<length><CR>
if PDU mode (+CMGF=0) and sending successful:
PDU is given <ctrl-Z/ESC>
+CMGC=?
+CMGC: <mr>[,<ackpdu>]
if sending fails:
+CMS ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<length>Length of PDU
<pdu>
See ”AT+CMGL”
<mr>
Message reference
<fo>
depending on the command or result code: first octet of
GSM 03.40 SMS-DELIVER, SMS-SUBMIT (default 17),
SMS- STATUS-REPORT, or SMS -COMMAND (default 2)
in integer format
<ct>
GSM 03.40 TP-Command-Type in integer format (default 0)
<pid>
GSM 03.40 TP-Protocol-Identifier in integer format (default
0)
<toda> GSM 04.11 TP-Destination-Address Type-of-Address octet
in integer format (when first character of <da> is + (IRA 43)
default is 145, otherwise default is 129)
<da>
GSM 03.40 TP-Destination-Address Address-Value field in
string format; BCD numbers (or GSM default alphabet
characters) are converted into characters; type of address
given by <toda>
<scts>
GSM 03.40 TP-Service-Centre-Time-Stamp in time-string
format (refer to <dt> )
Reference
Note
GSM 07.05
• After invoking the commands CMGW, CMGS or CMGC it is necessary to wait for the ">" symbol before entering text or PDU.
• At baudrates below 19200 it is recommended to use the line
termination character only (refer to +ATS3, default <CR>, pg. 26)
before entering the text/pdu. Use of the line termination character followed by the response formating character (refer to +ATS4,
default <LF>, pg. 26) can cause problems.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 126 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.2
AT+CMGD Delete SMS message
Test command
Response
AT+CMGD=?
OK
Parameter
Execute command
Response
AT+CMGD=
<index>
TA deletes message from preferred message storage <mem1> location <index>.
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CMS ERROR <err>
Parameter
<index> integer type; value in the range of location numbers supported by
the associated memory
Reference
Note
GSM 07.05
If there is no SMS stored at the selected index, the response is OK too.
5.3
AT+CMGF Select SMS message format
Test command
Response
AT+CMGF=?
+CMGF: (list of supported <mode>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CMGF?
+CMGF: <mode> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+CMGF =
[<mode>]
TA sets parameter which specifies the input and output format of messages to
be used.
OK
Parameter
<mode>
Reference
0
PDU mode
1
text mode
Note
GSM 07.05
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 127 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.4
AT+CMGL List SMS messages from preferred store
Test command
Response
AT+CMGL=?
+CMGL: (list of supported <stat>s) OK
Parameter
See execute command
Execute command
Parameter
AT+CMGL[=
<stat>]
1) If text mode:
<stat>
“REC UNREAD”
Received unread messages (default)
“REC READ”
Received read messages
“STO UNSENT”
Stored unsent messages
“STO SENT”
Stored sent messages
“ALL”
All messages
2) If PDU mode:
<stat>
0
Received unread messages (default)
1
Received read messages
2
Stored unsent messages
3
Stored sent messages
4
All messages
Response
TA returns messages with status value <stat> from message storage <mem1>
to the TE. If status of the message is ‘received unread’, status in the storage
changes to ‘received read’.
Note: If the selected <mem1> can contain different types of SMs (e.g. SMSDELIVERs, SMS- SUBMITs, SMS- STATUS-REPORTs and SMSCOMMANDs), the response may be a mix of the responses of different SM
types. TE application can recognize the response format by examining the
third response parameter.
Response
1) If text mode (+CMGF=1) and command successful:
for SMS- SUBMITs and/or SMS-DELIVERs:
+CMGL: <index>,<stat>,<oa/da>,[<alpha>],[<scts>][,<tooa/toda>,
<length>]<CR><LF><data>[<CR><LF>
+CMGL: <index>,<stat>,<da/oa>,[<alpha>],[<scts>][,<tooa/toda>,
<length>]<CR><LF><data>[...]] OK
for SMS-STATUS-REPORTs:
+CMGL: <index>,<stat>,<fo>,<mr>,[<ra>],[<tora>],<scts>,<dt>,<st>
[<CR><LF>
+CMGL: <index>,<stat>,<fo>,<mr>,[<ra>],[<tora>],<scts>,<dt>,<st>
[...]] OK
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 128 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
for SMS-COMMANDs:
+CMGL: <index>,<stat>,<fo>,<ct>[<CR><LF>
+CMGL: <index>,<stat>,<fo>,<ct>[...]] OK
for CBM storage:
+CMGL: <index>,<stat>,<sn>,<mid>,<page>,<pages><CR><LF><data>[<CR><LF>
+CMGL: <index>,<stat>,<sn>,<mid>,<page>,<pages>
<CR><LF><data>[...]]OK
2) If PDU mode (+CMGF=0) and command successful:
+CMGL: <index>,<stat>,[<alpha>],<length><CR><LF><pdu>
[<CR><LF>+CMGL: <index>,<stat>,[alpha],<length><CR><LF><pdu>
[...]] OK
for CBM storage:
+CMGL: <index>,<length><CR><LF><pdu>
3) If error is related to ME functionality:
+CMS ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<alpha> string type alphanumeric representation of <da> or <oa> corresponding to the entry found in phonebook; implementation of this
feature is manufacturer- specific
<ct>
GSM 03.40 TP-Command-Type in integer format (default 0)
<da>
GSM 03.40 TP-Destination-Address Address-Value field in string
format; BCD numbers (or GSM default alphabet characters) are
converted into characters; type of address given by <toda>
<data>
In case of SMS: GSM 03.40 TP-User-Data in text mode responses; format:
- if <dcs> indicates that GSM 03.38 default alphabet is used and <fo> indicates that GSM 03.40 TP-User-Data-Header-Indication is not set:
ME/TA converts GSM alphabet into current TE character set according to rules of Annex A
- if <dcs> indicates that 8-bit or UCS2 data coding scheme is used, or <fo>
indicates that GSM 03.40 TP-User-Data-Header-Indication is set:
ME/TA converts each 8-bit octet into hexadecimal numbers containing two IRA characters (e.g. octet with integer value 42 is
presented to TE as two characters 2A (IRA 50 and 65))
In the case of CBS: GSM 03.41 CBM Content of Message in text mode responses; format:
- if <dcs>indicates that GSM 03.38 default alphabet is used: ME/TA converts GSM alphabet into current TE character set according to
rules of Annex A
- if <dcs> indicates that 8-bit or UCS2 data coding scheme is used: ME/TA
converts each 8-bit octet into hexadecimal numbers containing
two IRA characters
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 129 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Parameter
<dt>
GSM 03.40 TP-Discharge-Time in time-string format: “yy/MM/
dd,hh:mm:ss±zz”, where characters indicate year (two last digits),
month, day, hour, minutes, seconds and time zone. For example,
6th of May 1994, 22:10:00 GMT+2 hours equals
“94/05/06,22:10:00+08”
<fo>
depending on the command or result code: first octet of GSM 03.40
SMS-DELIVER, SMS-SUBMIT (default 17), SMS- STATUSREPORT, or SMS -COMMAND (default 2) in integer format
<length> integer type value indicating in the text mode (+CMGF=1) the length
of the message body <data> (or <cdata>) in characters; or in PDU
mode (+CMGF=0), the length of the actual TP data unit in octets
(i.e. the RP layer SMSC address octets are not counted in the
length)
<index> integer type; value in the range of location numbers supported by
the associated memory
<mid>
GSM 03.41 CBM Message Identifier in integer format
<mr>
GSM 03.40 TP-Message-Reference in integer format
<oa>
GSM 03.40 TP-Originating-Address Address-Value field in string
format; BCD numbers (or GSM default alphabet characters) are
converted into characters; type of address given by <tooa>
<pages> GSM 03.41 CBM Page Parameter bits 0-3 in integer format
Reference
<pdu>
In the case of SMS: GSM 04.11 SC address followed by GSM 03.40
TPDU in hexadecimal format: ME/TA converts each octet of TP data
unit into hexadecimal numbers containing two IRA characters (e.g.
octet with integer value 42 is presented to TE as two characters 2A
(IRA 50 and 65)). In the case of CBS: GSM 03.41 TPDU in hexadecimal format.
<page>
GSM 03.41 CBM Page Parameter bits 4-7 in integer format
<ra>
GSM 03.40 TP-Recipient-Address Address-Value field in string
format; BCD numbers (or GSM default alphabet characters) are
converted into characters; type of address given by <tora>
<scts>
GSM 03.40 TP- Service-Centre-Time-Stamp in time-string format
(refer <dt>)
<sn>
GSM 03.41 CBM Serial Number in integer format
<st>
GSM 03.40 TP-Status in integer format
<toda>
GSM 04.11 TP-Destination-Address Type-of-Address octet in integer format (when first character of <da> is + (IRA 43) default is 145,
otherwise default is 129)
<tooa>
GSM 04.11 TP-Originating-Address Type-of-Address octet in integer format (default refer<toda>)
<tora>
GSM 04.11 TP-Recipient-Address Type-of-Address octet in integer
format (default refer<toda>)
Note
GSM 07.05
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 130 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.5
AT+CMGR Read SMS message
Test command
Response
AT+CMGR=?
OK
Execute command
Parameter
AT+CMGR=
<index>
<index> integer type; value in the range of location numbers supported by the
associated memory
Response
TA returns SMS message with location value <index> from message storage
<mem1> to the TE. If status of the message is ‘received unread’, status in the
storage changes to ‘received read’.
1) If text mode (+CMGF=1) and command successful:
for SMS-DELIVER:
+CMGR: <stat>,<oa>,[<alpha>],<scts> [,<tooa>,<fo>,<pid>,<dcs>,
<sca>,<tosca>,<length>]<CR><LF><data>
for SMS-SUBMIT:
+CMGR: <stat>,<da>,[<alpha>] [,<toda>,<fo>,<pid>,<dcs>,[<vp>],
<sca>,<tosca>,<length>]<CR><LF><data>
for SMS-STATUS-REPORT:
+CMGR: <stat>,<fo>,<mr>,[<ra>],[<tora>],<scts>,<dt>,<st>
for SMS- COMMAND:
+CMGR: <stat>,<fo>,<ct> [,<pid>,[<mn>],[<da>],[<toda>],<length>
<CR><LF><cdata>]
for CBM storage:
+CMGR: <stat>,<sn>,<mid>,<dcs>,<page>,<pages><CR><LF><data>
2) If PDU mode (+CMGF=0) and command successful:
+CMGR: <stat>,[<alpha>],<length><CR><LF><pdu> OK
for CBM storage:
+CMGR: <length><CR><LF><pdu>
3)If error is related to ME functionality:
+CMS ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<alpha> string type alphanumeric representation of <da> or <oa> corresponding
to the entry found in phonebook; implementation of this feature is manufacturer specific
<stat>
integer type in PDU mode (default 0), or string type in text mode (default
“REC UNREAD”); indicates the status of message in memory: defined
values:
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 131 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
0
1
2
3
“REC UNREAD” received unread message (i.e. new message)
“REC READ” received read message
“STO UNSENT” stored unsent message (only applicable to SMs)
“STO SENT” stored sent message (only applicable to SMs)
<ct> GSM 03.40 TP-Command-Type in integer format (default 0)
<da> GSM 03.40 TP- Destination-Address Address-Value field in string format;
BCD numbers (or GSM default alphabet characters) are converted into characters; type of address given by <toda>
<data>
In case of SMS: GSM 03.40 TP-User-Data in text mode responses; format:
-if <dcs> indicates that GSM 03.38 default alphabet is used and <fo> indicates that GSM 03.40 TP-User-Data-Header-Indication is not set:
ME/TA converts GSM alphabet into current TE character set according to rules covered in Annex A
-if <dcs> indicates that 8-bit or UCS2 data coding scheme is used, or <fo>
indicates that GSM 03.40 TP-User-Data-Header-Indication is set:
ME/TA converts each 8-bit octet into hexadecimal numbers containing two IRA characters (e.g. octet with integer value 42 is presented to TE as two characters 2A (IRA 50 and 65)
In case of CBS: GSM 03.41 CBM Content of Message in text mode responses; format:
- if <dcs> indicates that GSM 03.38 default alphabet is used: ME/TA converts
GSM alphabet into current TE character set according to rules covered in Annex A
-if <dcs> indicates that 8-bit or UCS2 data coding scheme is used: ME/TA
converts each 8-bit octet into hexadecimal numbers containing two
IRA characters
<dcs>
depending on the command or result code: GSM 03.38 SMS Data Coding Scheme (default 0), or Cell Broadcast Data Coding Scheme in integer format
<cdata> GSM 03.40 TP-Command-Data in text mode responses; ME/TA converts each 8-bit octet into two IRA character long hexadecimal numbers
(e.g. octet with integer value 42 is presented to TE as two characters 2A
(IRA 50 and 65))
GSM 03.40
TP-Discharge-Time in time-string format: ”yy/MM/
dd,hh:mm:ss±zz”, where characters indicate year (two last digits),
month, day, hour, minutes, seconds and time zone. For example, 6th of
May 1994, 22:10:00 GMT+2 hours equals ”94/05/06,22:10:00+08”
<fo>
depending on the command or result code: first octet of GSM 03.40
SMS- DELIVER, SMS-SUBMIT (default 17), SMS-STATUS-REPORT,
or SMS-COMMAND (default 2) in integer format
<length> integer type value indicating in text mode (+CMGF=1) the length of the
message body <data> (or <cdata>) in characters; or in PDU mode
(+CMGF=0), the length of the actual TP data unit in octets (i.e. the RP
layer SMSC address octets are not counted in the length).
<dt>
In text mode, the maximum length of an SMS depends on the used
coding scheme: It is 160 characters if the 7 bit GSM coding scheme is
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 132 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
used, and 140 characters according to the 8 bit GSM coding scheme.
<index> integer type; value in the range of location numbers supported by the
associated memory
<mid>
GSM 03.41 CBM Message Identifier in integer format
<mr>
GSM 03.40 TP-Message-Reference in integer format
<oa>
GSM 03.40 TP-Originating-Address Address-Value field in string format; BCD numbers (or GSM default alphabet characters) are converted
into characters; type of address given by <tooa>
<page> GSM 03.41 CBM Page Parameter bits 4-7 in integer format
<pages> GSM 03.41 CBM Page Parameter bits 0-3 in integer format
<pdu> In the case of SMS: GSM 04.11 SC address followed by GSM 03.40
TPDU in hexadecimal format: ME/TA converts each octet of TP data unit
into hexadecimal numbers containing two IRA characters (e.g. octet with
integer value 42 is presented to TE as two characters 2A (IRA 50 and
65)). In the case of CBS: <ra> GSM 03.40 TP-Recipient-Address Address-Value field in string format; BCD numbers (or GSM default alphabet characters) are converted into characters; type of address given by
<tora>
<pid>
GSM 03.40 TP-Protocol-Identifier in integer format (default 0)
<ra>
GSM 03.40 TP-Recipient-Address Address-Value field in string format;
BCD numbers (or GSM default alphabet characters) are converted to
characters of the currently selected TE character set (refer command
AT+CSCS Select TE character set.); type of address given by <tora>
<sca>
GSM 04.11 RP SC address Address-Value field in string format; BCD
numbers (or GSM default alphabet characters) are converted to characters of the currently selected TE character set (refer command
AT+CSCS Select TE character set); type of address given by <tosca>
GSM 03.40 TP-Service-Centre-Time-Stamp in time-string format (refer
<dt>)
GSM 03.41 CBM Serial Number in integer format
GSM 03.40 TP-Status in integer format
GSM 04.11 TP-Destination-Address Type-of-Address octet in integer
format (when first character of <da> is + (IRA 43) default is 145, otherwise default is 129)
GSM 04.11 TP-Originating-Address Type-of-Address octet in integer
format (default refer<toda>)
GSM 04.11 TP-Recipient-Address Type-of-Address octet in integer format (default refer<toda>)
<scts>
<sn>
<st>
<toda>
<tooa>
<tora>
<tosca>
GSM 04.11 RP SC address Type-of-Address octet in integer format
(default refer <toda>)
<vp>
depending on SMS-SUBMIT <fo> setting: GSM 03.40 TP-Validity-Period
either in integer format (default 167) or in time-string format (refer <dt>)
Reference
Note
GSM 07.05
Response to a CMGR to an empty record index: +CMGR: 0,,0
Response to a CMGR to a not existing record index: +CMS ERROR: invalid
memory index
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 133 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.6
AT+CMGS Send SMS message
Test command
Response
AT+CMGS=?
OK
Parameter
Execute command
Response
1) If text mode
(+CMGF=1):
+CMGS=<da>
[,<toda>]<CR>
text is entered
<ctrl-Z/ESC>
TA transmits SMS message from TE to network (SMS-SUBMIT). Message
reference value <mr> is returned to TE on successful message delivery.
Value can be used to identify message upon unsolicited delivery status report result code.
2) If PDU mode
(+CMGF=0):
+CMGS=<length>
<CR>
PDU is given <ctrlZ/ESC>
ESC aborts message
1) If text mode (+CMGF=1) and sending successful:
+CMGS: <mr>[,scts>] OK
2) If PDU mode (+CMGF=0) and sending successful:
+CMGS: <mr>[,ackpdu>] OK
3) If error is related to ME functionality:
+CMS ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<da>
GSM 03.40 TP-Destination-Address Address-Value field in string
format; BCD numbers (or GSM default alphabet characters) are
converted into characters; type of address given by <toda>
<toda>
GSM 04.11 TP-Destination-Address Type-of-Address octet in integer format (when first character of <da> is + (IRA 43) default is
145, otherwise default is 129)
<length> integer type value indicating in text mode (+CMGF=1) the length of
the message body <data> (or <cdata>) in characters; or in PDU
mode (+CMGF=0), the length of the actual TP data unit in octets
(i.e. the RP layer SMSC address octets are not counted in the
length)
In text mode, the maximum length of an SMS depends on the
used coding scheme: It is 160 characters if the 7 bit GSM coding
scheme is used, and 140 characters according to the 8 bit GSM
coding scheme.
<mr>
GSM 03.40 TP-Message-Reference in integer format
<scts>
GSM 03.40 TP-Service-Centre-Time-Stamp in time-string format
(refer <dt>)
<dt>
GSM 03.40 TP-Discharge-Time in time-string format: “yy/MM/
dd,hh:mm:ss±zz”, where characters indicate year (two last digits),
month, day, hour, minutes, seconds and time zone. For example,
6th of May 1994, 22:10:00 GMT+2 hours equals
“94/05/06,22:10:00+08”
<ackpdu>GSM 03.40 RP-User-Data element of RP-ACK PDU; format is
same as for <pdu> in case of SMS, but without GSM 04.11 SC
address field and parameter shall be enclosed in double quote
characters like a normal string type parameter
<pdu>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
For SMS: GSM 04.11 SC address followed by GSM 03.40 TPDU
in hexadecimal format: ME/TA converts each octet of TP data unit
into hexadecimal numbers containing two IRA characters (e.g.
octet with integer value 42 is presented to TE as two characters
2A (IRA 50 and 65)). In the case of CBS: GSM 03.41 TPDU in
hexadecimal format.
Page 134 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Reference
Note
GSM 07.05
• Use CTRL-Z at the end of input to send the message and return OK.
• Use ESC at the end of message input to abort message send operation.
NO message is sent although display returns OK!
• Sending e-mails via SMS: Note that some providers do not recognise @
symbol. Possible alternative “!” for “@”
• After invoking of the command CMGW, CMGS, CMGC it is necessary to
wait for the ">" symbol and only afterwards the text can be sent to the
module
• At baudrates lower than 19200 it is recommended to use the line termination character only (refer to +ATS3, default <CR>, pg. 26) before entering the text/pdu. Use of the line termination character followed by the
response formating character (see +ATS4, default <LF>, pg. 26) can
cause problems.
• All characters entered behind the “>” symbol will be recognized as GSM
characters. For example, “Backspace” (ASCII character 8) does not delete a character, but will be inserted into the SMS as an additional physical character. As a result, the character you wanted to delete still appears in the text, plus the GSM code equivalent of the Backspace key.
See also Chapter 9.5 which provides the supported alphabet tables.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 135 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.7
AT+CMGW Write SMS message to memory
Test command
Response
AT+CMGW=?
OK
Execute command
Response
1) If text mode
(+CMGF=1):
+CMGW[=<oa/da>
[,tooa/toda>[,stat>]]]
<CR> text is entered
ctrl-Z/ESC><ESC>
quits without sending
TA transmits SMS (either SMS-DELIVER or SMS-SUBMIT) from TE to
memory storage <mem2>. Memory location <index> of the stored message
is returned. Message status will be set to ‘stored unsent’ unless otherwise
given in parameter <stat>.
2) If PDU mode
(+CMGF=0):
+CMGW=<length>
[,stat]<CR>
PDU is given <ctrlZ/ESC>
SMS-COMMANDs and SMS-STATUS-REPORTs cannot be stored in
text mode.
Note:
If writing is successful:
+CMGW: <index> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CMS ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<oa>
GSM 03.40 TP-Originating-Address Address value field in string
format; BCD numbers (or GSM default alphabet characters) are
converted into characters; type of address given by <tooa>
<da>
GSM 03.40 TP-Destination-Address Address-Value field in string
format; BCD numbers (or GSM default alphabet characters) are
converted into characters; type of address given by <toda>
<tooa>
GSM 04.11 TP-Originating-Address Type-of-Address octet in integer format (default refer <toda>)
<toda>
GSM 04.11 TP-Destination-Address Type-of-Address octet in integer format (when first character of <da> is + (IRA 43) default is
145, otherwise default is 129)
<length> integer type value indicating in the text mode (+CMGF=1) the
length of the message body <data> (or <cdata>) in characters; or
in PDU mode (+CMGF=0), the length of the actual TP data unit in
octets (i.e. the RP layer SMSC address octets are not counted in
the length).
In text mode, the maximum length of an SMS depends on the
used coding scheme: It is 160 characters if the 7 bit GSM coding
scheme is used, and 140 characters according to the 8 bit GSM
coding scheme.
<stat>
<pdu>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
integer type in PDU mode (default 0), or string type in text mode
(defauld “REC UNREAD“); indicates the status of message in
memory; defined values:
0 “REC UNREAD”
Received unread messages (default)
1 “REC READ”
Received read messages
2 “STO UNSENT”
Stored unsent messages
3 “STO SENT”
Stored sent messages
In the case of SMS: GSM 04.11 SC address followed by GSM
03.40 TPDU in hexadecimal format: ME/TA converts each octet of
TP data unit into hexadecimal numbers containing two IRA characters (e.g. octet with integer value 42 is presented to TE as two
characters 2A (IRA 50 and 65)). In the case of CBS: GSM 03.41
Page 136 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
TPDU in hexadecimal format.
<index> Index of message in selected storage <mem2>
Reference
Note
GSM 07.05
• Use CTRL-Z at the end of input to send the message and return OK.
• Use ESC at the end of message input to abort message send operation.
NO message is sent although display returns OK!
• Sending e-mails via SMS: Note that some providers do not recognise @
symbol. Possible alternative “!” for “@”
• After invoking of the command CMGW, CMGS, CMGC it is necessary to
wait for the ">" symbol and only afterwards the text can be sent to the
module
• At baudrates lower than 19200 it is recommended to use the line termination character only (refer to +ATS3, default <CR>, pg. 26) before entering the text/pdu. Use of the line termination character followed by the
response formating character (refer to +ATS4, default <LF>, pg. 26) can
cause problems.
• All characters entered behind the “>” symbol will be recognized as GSM
characters. For example, “Backspace” (ASCII character 8) does not delete a character, but will be inserted into the SMS as an additional physical character. As a result, the character you wanted to delete still appears in the text, plus the GSM code equivalent of the Backspace key.
See also Chapter 9.5 which provides the supported alphabet tables.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 137 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.8
AT+CMSS Send SMS message from storage
Test command
Response
AT+CMSS=?
OK
Parameter
Execute command
Response
+CMSS=
<index>[,<da>
[,<toda>]]
TA sends message with location value <index> from message storage
<mem2> to the network (SMS-SUBMIT or SMS-COMMAND). If new recipient address <da> is given for SMS-SUBMIT, it shall be used instead of the
one stored with the message. Reference value <mr> is returned to the TE
on successful message delivery. Values can be used to identify message
upon unsolicited delivery status report result code.
1) If text mode (+CMGF=1) and send successful:
+CMSS: <mr>[,scts>] OK
2) If PDU mode (+CMGF=0) and send successful:
+CMSS: <mr>[,ackpdu>] OK
3) If error is related to ME functionality:
+CMS ERROR: <err>
Parameter
Reference
<ackpdu>
GSM 03.40 RP-User-Data element of RP-ACK PDU;
format is same as for <pdu> in case of SMS, but without
GSM 04.11 SC address field and parameter shall be
bounded by double quote characters like a normal string
type parameter.
<index>
integer type; value in the range of location numbers supported by the associated memory
<da>
GSM 03.40 TP-Destination-Address Address-Value field
in string format; BCD numbers (or GSM default alphabet
characters) are converted into characters; type of address given by <toda>
<scts>
GSM 03.40 TP-Service-Centre-Time-Stamp in timestring format.
<toda>
GSM 04.11 TP-Destination-Address Type-of-Address
octet in integer format (when first character of <da> is +
(IRA 43) default is 145, otherwise default is 129)
<mr>
GSM 03.40 TP-Message-Reference in integer format
Note
GSM 07.05
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 138 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.9
AT+CNMA New SMS message acknowledge to ME/TE, only phase 2+
Test command
Response
AT+CNMA=?
1) If text mode (+CMGF=1):
OK
2) If PDU mode (+CMGF=0):
+CNMA: (list of supported <n>s) OK
Parameters
See execute command
Execute command
Response
1) If text mode:
AT+CNMA
TA confirms successful receipt of a new message (SMS-DELIVER or SMSSTATUS-REPORT) which is routed directly to the TE. TA shall not send another +CMT or +CDS result code to TE until previous one is acknowledged.
If ME does not receive acknowledgment within required time (network timeout), ME sends RP-ERROR to the network. TA shall automatically disable
routing to TE by setting both <mt> and <ds> values of +CNMI to zero.
2) If PDU mode:
AT+CNMA[=<n>]
Note:
The command shall o n l y be used when +CSMS parameter <service> equals 1 (= phase 2+).
1) If text mode:
OK
2) If PDU mode:
OK
3) If error is related to ME functionality:
+CMS ERROR: <err>
Parameters
<n>
0 command operates similarly as defined for the text mode
Reference
Note
GSM 07.05
If multiplex mode is activated (+CMUX=0) the +CNMI parameter will be set to
zero on all channels, if one channel fails to acknowledge an incoming message within the required time.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 139 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.10 AT+CNMI New SMS message indications
Test command
Response
AT+CNMI=?
+CNMI: (list of supported <mode>s), (list of supported <mt>s), (list of supported
<bm>s), (list of supported <ds>s), (list of supported <bfr>s) OK
Parameter
See set command
Read command
Response
AT+CNMI?
+CNMI: <mode>,<mt>,<bm>,<ds>,<bfr> OK
Parameter
See set command
Write command
Response
AT+CNMI =
[<mode>]
[,<mt>][,<bm>]
[,<ds>][,<bfr>]
TA selects the procedure how the receipt of new SMS messages from the network
is indicated to the TE when TE is active, e.g. DTR signal is ON. If TE is inactive
(e.g. DTR signal is OFF), the reception of messages shall be performed as specified in GSM 03.38.
Note1:
If the DTR signal is not available or the state of the signal is ignored
(V.25ter command &D0), reliable message transfer can be assured by
using +CNMA acknowledgment procedure.
Note2:
The rules <mt>=2 and <mt>=3 for storing received SM are possible only if
phase 2+ compatibility is activated with +CSMS=1
Note3:
The parameter <ds>=1 is only available in phase 2+
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CMS ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<mode>
<mt>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
0
Buffer unsolicited result codes in the TA. If TA result code
buffer is full, indications can be buffered in some other place or
the oldest indications may be discarded and replaced with the
new received indications.
1
Discard indication and reject new received message
unsolicited result codes when TA-TE link is reserved (e.g. in
on-line data mode). Otherwise forward them directly to the TE.
2
Buffer unsolicited result codes in the TA when TA-TE link is reserved (e.g. in on-line data mode) and flush them to the TE
after reservation. Otherwise forward them directly to the TE.
3
Forward unsolicited result codes directly to the TE. TA-TE link
specific inband technique used to embed result codes and data
when TA is in on-line data mode.
Rules for storing received SMS depend on the relevant data coding
method (refer to GSM 03.38 [2]), preferred memory storage (+CPMS)
setting and this value
Note: If AT command interface is acting as the only display device, the
ME must support storage of class 0 messages and messages in the
message waiting indication group (discard message)
0
No SMS-DELIVER indications are routed to the TE.
1
If SMS-DELIVER is stored in ME/TA, indication of the memory
location is routed to the TE using unsolicited result code:
+CMTI: <mem>,<index>
Page 140 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
<bm>
<ds>
<bfr>
Unsolicited result
code
2
SMS-DELIVERs, except class 2 messages and messages in
the message waiting indication group (store message) are
routed directly to the TE using unsolicited result code:
+CMT: ,<length><CR><LF><pdu> (PDU mode enabled)
+CMT: <oa>,, <scts> [,<tooa>, <fo>, <pid>, <dcs>, <sca>, <tosca>, <length>] <CR> <LF> <data> (text mode enabled)
3
Class 3 SMS-DELIVERs are routed directly to the TE using
unsolicited result codes defined in <mt>=2. Messages of other
data coding schemes result in indication as defined in <mt>=1.
Rules for storing received CBMs depend on the relevant data coding
method (refer to GSM 03.38 [2]), the setting of Select CBM Types
(+CSCB) and this value:
0
No CBM indications are routed to the TE.
2
New CBMs are routed directly to the TE using unsolicited result code: +CBM: <length><CR><LF><pdu> (PDU mode enabled) or +CBM: <sn>,<mid>,<dcs>,<page>,<pages><CR>
<LF><data> (text mode enabled).
3
Class 3 CBMs are routed directly to TE using unsolicited result
codes defined in <bm>=2.
0
No SMS-STATUS-REPORTs are routed to the TE.
1
SMS-STATUS-REPORTs are routed to the TE using unsolicited result code: +CDS: <length><CR><LF><pdu> (PDU mode
enabled) or +CDS: <fo>,<mr>,[<ra>],[<tora>],<scts>,<dt>, <st>
(text mode enabled)
2
If SMS-STATUS-REPORT is routed into ME/TA, indication of
the memory location is routed to the TE using unsolicited result
code: +CDSI: <mem>,<index>
1
TA buffer of unsolicited result codes defined within this command is cleared when <mode> 1...3 is entered.
Syntax of responses output when SMS is received:
+CMTI: <mem>,<index>
Indicates that new message has been received
+CBMI: <mem>,<index>
Indicates that new CB message has been received
+CMT: ,<length><CR><LF><pdu> Short message is output directly
+CBM: <length><CR><LF><pdu>
Cell broadcast message is output directly
During each SMS or Cell Broadcast Messages the Ring Line goes Logic “1“ for
one second.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 141 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Reference
Note
GSM 07.05
• Parameters <mt>=2,3 and <ds>=1 are only available with GSM phase 2+ (see
+CSMS=1). Incoming SMs or Status Reports have to be acknowledged with
AT+CNMA=0 when using these phase 2+ parameters.
• According to GSM 03.38 the ME treats short messages with message class 0
as though there was no message class, i.e. it will ignore bits 0 and 1 in the TPDCS and normal rules for exceeded memory capacity shall apply.
Requirements specific to Multiplex mode:
• In multiplex mode (AT+CMUX=0) only one channel can use a phase 2+ parameter. The parameter for <mt> and <ds> on the other channels have to be
set to zero.
• If either a SM or a Status Report is not acknowledged, all +CNMI parameter in
all channels will be set to zero.
5.11 AT+CPMS Preferred SMS message storage
Test command
Response
AT+CPMS=?
+CPMS: (list of supported <mem1>s), (list of supported <mem2>s), (list of supported <mem3>s)
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CPMS?
+CPMS: <mem1>,<used1>,<total1>,<mem2>,<used2>,<total2>,
<mem3>,<used3>,<total3> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CMS ERROR
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+CPMS=
<mem1>
[,<mem2>
[,<mem3>]]
TA selects memory storages <mem1>, <mem2> and <mem3> to be used for reading, writing, etc.
+CPMS: <used1>,<total1>,<used2>,<total2>,<used3>,<total3> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CMS ERROR:<err>
Parameter
<mem1> Memory to be used when listing, reading and deleting messages:
“SM”
SIM message storage
“ME”
Mobile Equipment message storage
“MT”
Sum of “ME” and “SM” storages
<mem2> Memory to be used when writing and sending messages:
“SM”
SIM message storage
“ME”
Mobile Equipment message storage
“MT”
Sum of “ME” and “SM” storages
<mem3> Received messages will be placed to this storage if routing to TE is not
set. See AT+CNMI command with parameter <mt>=2 (Chapter 5.10).
“MT”
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Sum of “ME” and “SM” storages
Page 142 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
<usedx> Number of messages currently in <memx>
<totalx> Number of messages storable in <memx>
Reference
Note
GSM 07.05
• The Mobile Equipment storage "ME" offers space for 25 short messages.
• The storage "MT" is the sum of the storages "ME" and "SM". The indices (<index>) from 1 to 25 are associated to the "ME" storage. Indices equal to 26 and
higher are allocated to the "SM" storage.
• <mem1> and <mem2> are set to “MT” by default. Alternatively, the two parameters “SM” or “ME” can be selected during the current session, giving access either to the SIM card storage or to the device storage. Once the module
is powered down or reset the default setting “MT” will be restored.
• <mem3> memory is set to “MT” and does not offer the choice between “SM”
and “ME”. The user should be aware that “MT” involves “ME” and “SM”, with
“ME” being filled up first. If the "ME" storage is full, MC35 will proceed with the
"SM" storage.
Incoming Class 1 short messages (ME specific) will be preferably stored to
“ME” and may be transferred to the “SM” storage if “ME” is used up.
Incoming Class 2 messages (SIM specific) will be stored to the SIM card only,
no matter whether or not there is free “ME” space.
As a result, the ^SMGO: 2 indication (see AT^SMGO in Chapter 8.15 may be
presented without prior indication of ^SMGO: 1. For more information regarding
SIM and ME specific message classes refer to <dcs> and the following specifications: GSM 03.38 and 3GPP TS 23.038.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 143 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.12 AT+CSCA SMS service centre address
Test command
Response
AT+CSCA=?
OK
Read command
Response
AT+CSCA?
+CSCA: <sca>,<tosca> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
AT+CSCA=<sca>
[,<tosca>]
TA updates the SMSC address, through which mobile originated SMs are
transmitted. In text mode, setting is used by send and write commands. In PDU
mode, setting is used by the same commands, but only when the length of the
SMSC address coded into <pdu> parameter equals zero.
Note:
This command writes the service centre address to non-volatile memory.
Response
OK
Parameter
<sca>
GSM 04.11 RP SC address Address value field in string format; BCD
numbers (or GSM default alphabet characters) are converted into
characters; type of address given by <tosca>
Maximum length of address: 20 characters
<tosca>
Service centre address format GSM 04.11 RP SC address Type-ofAddress octet in integer format (default refer <toda>)
Reference
Note
GSM 07.05
If no parameter is entered after AT+CSCA= the content of <sca> will be deleted.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 144 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.13 AT+CSCB Select cell broadcast messages
Test command
Response
AT+CSCB=?
+CSCB: (list of supported <mode>s)
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CSCB?
+CSCB: <mode>,<mids>,<dcss>
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Parameter
AT+CSCB=[<mode>
[,<mids>[,<dcss>]]]
<mode>
0
Accepts messages that are defined in <mids> and <dcss>
1
Does not accept messages that are defined in <mids>
and <dcss>
<mids>
String type; combinations of CBM message IDs (e.g.
"0,1,5,320-478,922"). The number of ranges in <mids> parameter string is limited to 6
<dcss>
String type; combinations of CBM data coding schemes (e.g.
"0-3,5")
Note:
If <mode>=1 is selected the parameter <mids> has to be given as only one
area (e.g. “0-99“)
Reference
Note
GSM 07.05
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 145 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.14 AT+CSDH Show SMS text mode parameters
Test command
Response
AT+CSDH=?
+CSDH: (list of supported <show>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CSDH?
+CSDH:<show> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+CSDH=
<show>
TA sets whether or not detailed header information is shown in text mode result
codes.
OK
Parameter
<show>
Reference
0
do not show header values defined in commands +CSCA
and +CSMP (<sca>, <tosca>, <fo>, <vp>, <pid> and <dcs>)
nor <length>, <toda> or <tooa> in +CMT, +CMGL, +CMGR
result codes for SMS-DELIVERs and SMS-SUBMITs in text
mode; for SMS-COMMANDs in +CMGR result code, do not
show <pid>, <mn>, <da>, <toda>, <length> or <cdata>
1
show the values in result codes
Note
GSM 07.05
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 146 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.15 AT+CSMP Set SMS text mode parameters
Test command
Response
AT+CSMP=?
OK
Read command
Response
AT+CSMP?
+CSMP:<fo>,<vp/scts>,<pid>,<dcs> OK
Parameter
See set command
Set command
Response
AT+CSMP=
<fo>[,<vp/scts>[
,<pid>
[,<dcs>]]]
TA selects values for additional parameters needed when SM is sent to the network or placed in a storage when text format message mode is selected. It is possible to set the validity period starting from when the SM is received by the SMSC
(<vp> is in range 0... 255) or define the absolute time of the validity period termination (<vp> is a string). The format of <vp> is given by <fo>. If TA supports the
enhanced validity period format, see GSM 03.40), it shall be given as a hexadezimal coded string (refer e.g. <pdu>) with quotes.
Note:
When storing a SMS_DELIVER from the TE to the preferred memory storage in
text mode (refer write command to Message Memory +CMGW), <vp> field can be
used for <scts>
Parameter
<fo>
depending on the command or result code: first octet of GSM 03.40
SMS-DELIVER, SMS-SUBMIT (default 17), or SMS-COMMAND (default
2) in integer format
<scts>
GSM 03.40 TP-Service-Centre-Time-Stamp in time-string format (refer
<dt>)
<vp>
depending on SMS-SUBMIT <fo> setting: GSM 03.40 TP-Validity-Period
either in integer format (default 167) ), in time-string format (refer <dt>),
or if is supported, in enhanced format (hexadecimal coded string with
quotes)
<pid>
Protocol-Identifier in integer format (default 0), refer GSM 03.40
<dcs>
SMS Data Coding Scheme (default 0), or Cell Broadcast Data Coding
Scheme in integer format depending on the command or result code:
GSM 03.38
Reference
Note
GSM 07.05
The command writes the parameters to the non-volatile memory.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 147 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
5.16 AT+CSMS Select Message Service
Test command
Response
AT+CSMS=?
+CSMS: (list of supported <service>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CSMS?
+CSMS: <service>,<mt>,<mo>,<bm> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT+CSMS=
<service>
+CSMS: <mt>,<mo>,<bm> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CMS ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<service>
<mt>
<mo>
<bm>
0
GSM 03.40 and 03.41 (the syntax of SMS AT commands is
compatible with GSM 07.05 Phase 2 version 4.7.0; Phase 2+
features which do not require new command syntax may be
supported, e.g. correct routing of messages with new Phase 2+
data coding schemes)
1
GSM 03.40 and 03.41 (the syntax of SMS AT commands is
compatible with GSM 07.05 Phase 2+ version; the requirement
of <service> setting 1 is mentioned under corresponding command descriptions).
Mobile Terminated Messages:
0
Type not supported
1
Type supported
Mobile Originated Messages:
0
Type not supported
1
Type supported
Broadcast Type Messages:
0
Type not supported
1
Type supported
Reference
Note
GSM 07.05
If CSMS Mode is switched from Phase 2+ to Phase 2 and one or more CNMI Parameter are Phase 2+ specific a '+CMS ERROR: unknown error' will appear. It is
recommended to switch the CNMI Parameters to Phase 2 specific values before
entering Phase 2.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 148 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
6 GPRS AT commands in accordance with GSM 07.07
This chapter provides GPRS specific AT commands. For information on using GPRS commands in
multiplex mode see chapter 4.28.
6.1
Commands specific to MTs supporting GPRS
This clause defines commands that a TE (Terminal Equipment, i.e. an application running on a controlling PC) may use to control a GPRS MT (Mobile Termination, the Wireless Module). Refer ro
Chapter 6.4 for selected examples of using GPRS AT commands.
6.1.1 AT+CGATT GPRS attach and detach
Test command
AT+CGATT=?
The test command is used for requesting information on the supported GPRS
service states.
Response
+CGATT: (list of supported <state>s)
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<state>
Read command
See write command
The read command returns the current GPRS service state.
AT+CGATT?
Response
+CGACT: <state>
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<state>
Write command
AT+CGATT=
[<state>]
See write command
The execution command enables the MT get attached to or detached from the
GPRS service. After the command has completed, the MT remains in V.25ter
command state. If the MT is already in the requested state, the command is ignored and the OK response is returned. Any active PDP contexts will be automatically deactivated when the attachment state changes to detached.
If the MT is not able to attach for more than 5 minutes, the command returns an
error code, though the MT is still trying to attach.
Parameter
<state>
indicates the state of GPRS attachment
0 – detached
1 – attached
Response
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Reference
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 149 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
6.1.2 AT+CGACT PDP context activate or deactivate
Test command
AT+CGACT=?
The test command is used for requesting information on the supported PDP
context activation states.
Response
+CGACT: (list of supported <state>s)
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<state>
Read command
AT+CGACT?
See write command
The read command returns the current activation states for all the defined
PDP contexts.
Response
+CGACT: <cid>, <state> [<CR><LF>+CGACT: <cid>, <state>...]
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<cid>
<state>
Write command
AT+CGACT=
[<state>[,<cid>[,<cid>
[,...]]]]
See write command
See write command
This command is used to activate or deactivate the specified PDP context(s). After the command has completed, the MT remains in V.25ter command state. If any PDP context is already in the requested state, the state
for that context remains unchanged. If the MT is not GPRS attached when
the activation form of the command is executed, the MT first performs a
GPRS attach and them attempts to activate the specified contexts. If no
<cid>s are specified the activation/deactivation form of the command activates/deactivates all defined contexts.
Response
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<state>
<cid>
indicates the state of PDP context activation
0 – deactivated
1 – activated
PDP Context Identifier is a numeric parameter which
specifies a particular PDP context definition. The parameter is local to the TE-MT interface and is used in
other PDP context-related commands.
Note: The range of supported cids is returned by
AT+CGDCONT=?
Response
+CGACT: (list of supported <state>s)
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
Please note that the execution of ATH deactivates any PDP context (see
Chapters 2.12, 4.16, 6.3.2)
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 150 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
6.1.3 AT+CGDATA Enter data state
Test command
AT+CGDATA=?
The test command is used for requesting information on the supported layer 2
protocols to be used between the TE and MT.
Response
+CGDATA: (list of supported <L2P>s)
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<L2P>
Write command
+CGDATA=[<L2P>,
[<cid>[,<cid>,…]]]]
See write command
The execution command causes the MT to perform whatever actions are necessary to establish communication between the TE and the network using one
or more GPRS PDP types. This may include performing a GPRS attach and
one or more PDP context activations. Commands following +CGDATA command in the AT command line shall not be processed by the MT.
Parameter
<L2P>
<cid>
layer 2 protocol to be used between the TE and MT
PPP or 1 for layer2 protocol PPP
PDP Context Identifier is a numeric parameter which
specifies a particular PDP context definition. The parameter is local to the TE-MT interface and is used in
PDP context-related commands. If no context is specified,
an internal context 0 with default QoS (network subscribed) and APN from EEPROM (if there is one) is used.
1
2
Response
If successful, the MT issues the intermediate result code CONNECT and enters V.25ter online data state:
CONNECT
After data transfer is complete, and the layer 2 protocol termination procedure
has completed successfully, the command state is re-entered and the MT returns the final result code
OK
If the <L2P> parameter value is unacceptable to the MT, the MT returns an
ERROR or +CME ERROR response:
ERROR/+CME ERROR
In the event of erroneous termination or a failure to start up, the command
state is re-entered and the MT returns
NO CARRIER
or, if enabled,
+CME ERROR
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 151 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
6.1.4 AT+CGDCONT Define PDP Context
Test command
AT+CGDCONT=?
The test command returns values supported as a compound value. If the
MT supports several PDP types, the parameter value ranges for each
<PDP_type> are returned on a separate line.
Response
+CGDCONT: (range of supported <cid>s), <PDP_type>,,,(list of supported
<d_comp>s), (list of supported <h_comp>s) [<CR><LF>+CGDCONT: ...]
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<cid>
<PDP_type>
<d_comp>
<h_comp>
Read command
AT+CGDCONT?
See write command
See write command
numeric parameter that controls PDP data compression
0 off
numeric parameter that controls PDP header compression
0 off
The read command returns the current settings for each defined context. If
there is no context define simply OK will be returned.
Response
+CGDCONT: <cid>, <PDP_type>, <APN>, <PDP_addr>, <data_comp>,
<head_comp> [<CR><LF>+CGDCONT: ...]
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<cid>
<PDP_type>
<APN>
<PDP_addr>
<d_comp>
<h_comp>
Write command
AT+CGDCONT=[<cid>
[,<PDP_type>[,<APN>
[,<PDP_addr>]]]]
See write command
See write command
See write command
See write command
See test command
See test command
This command specifies PDP context parameter values for a PDP context
identified by the (local) context identification parameter, <cid>. A special
form of the set command, +CGDCONT= <cid> causes the values for context number <cid> to become undefined. AT&F and ATZ will undefine
every context which is not active or not online.
Parameter
<cid>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
This PDP Context Identifier is a numeric parameter
which specifies a particular PDP context definition.
The parameter is local to the TE-MT interface and is
also used in other PDP context-related commands. If
no cid is given, nothing will be changed (neither context definition nor undefinition).
1
2
Page 152 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
<PDP_type>
<APN>
<PDP_addr>
Packet Data Protocol type is a string parameter which
specifies the type of packet data protocol:
IP
Internet Protocol (IETF STD 5)
Access Point Name is a string parameter (framed by
quotation marks) which is a logical name that is used
to select the GGSN or the external packet data network. If the value is null or omitted, then the subscription value will be requested.
String parameter that identifies the MT in the address
space applicable to the PDP (e.g. IP V4 address for
PDP type IP). If the value is null or omitted, then a
value may be provided by the TE during the PDP
startup procedure or, failing that, a dynamic address
will be requested.
Response
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Reference
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 153 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
6.1.5 AT+CGQMIN Quality of Service Profile (Minimum acceptable)
Test command
AT+CGQMIN=?
The test command returns values supported as a compound value. If the
MT supports several PDP types, the parameter value ranges for each PDP
type are returned on a separate line.
Response
+CGQMIN: <PDP_type>, (list of supported <precedence>s), (list of supported <delay>s), (list of supported <reliability>s) , (list of supported
<peak>s), (list of supported <mean>s) [<CR><LF>+CGQMIN: ...]
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<PDP_type>
<precedence>
<delay>
<reliability>
<peak>
<mean>
String parameter of Packet Data Protocol type
IP
See write command
See write command
See write command
See write command
See write command
Read command
Response
AT+CGQMIN?
The read command returns the current settings for each defined context. If
no minimum profile was explicitly specified for a context, simply OK will be
returned, but default values will be used for that context.
+CGQMIN: <cid>, <precedence>, <delay>, <reliability>, <peak>, <mean>
[<CR><LF>+CGQMIN: ...]
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<cid>
<precedence>
<delay>
<reliability>
<peak>
<mean>
Write command
AT+CGQMIN=
[<cid>[,<precedence>
[,<delay>[,<reliability>
[,<peak>[,<mean>]]]]]]
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
See write command
See write command
See write command
See write command
See write command
See write command
This command allows the TE to specify a minimum acceptable profile
which is checked by the MT against the negotiated profile returned in the
Activate PDP Context Accept message.
The set command specifies a profile for the context identified by the (local)
context identification parameter, <cid>.
A special form of the set command, +CGQMIN= <cid> causes the minimum acceptable profile for context number <cid> to become undefined. In
this case no check is made against the negotiated profile.
AT&F and ATZ will undefine the minimum QoS profiles of every context
which is not active or not online.
Page 154 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Parameter
<cid>
numeric PDP Context Identifier; if no cid is specified,
nothing will be changed (no profile definition / undefinition)
1
2
<precedence>
numeric parameter for the precedence class
0 network subscribed value
1 High Priority
Service commitments shall be maintained ahead of
precedence classes 2 and 3
2 Normal priority
Service commitments shall be maintained ahead of
precedence class 3
3 Low priority
Service commitments shall be maintained ahead of
precedence classes 1 and 2
<delay>
numeric parameter for the delay class
0 network subscribed value
SDU size: 128 octets:
Delay Class
Mean Transfer Delay 95 percentile
Delay
1 (Predictive)
<0.5
<1.5
2 (Predictive)
<5
< 25
3 (Predictive)
< 50
< 250
4 (Best Effort)
Unspecified
SDU size: 1024 octets:
Delay Class
Mean Transfer Delay 95 percentile
Delay
1 (Predictive)
<0.5
<1.5
2 (Predictive)
<5
< 25
3 (Predictive)
< 50
< 250
4 (Best Effort) Unspecified
The delay parameter defines the end-to-end transfer delay incurred in the transmission of SDUs through the GPRS network(s).
<reliability>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
numeric parameter for the reliability class
0 network subscribed value
1 Non real-time traffic , error-sensitive application
that cannot cope with data loss
2 Non real-time traffic, error-sensitive application
that can cope with infrequent data loss
3 Non real-time traffic, error-sensitive application
that can cope with data loss, GMM/SM, and SMS
4 Real-time traffic, error-sensitive application that
can cope with data loss
5 Real-time traffic, error non-sensitive application
that can cope with data loss
Page 155 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
<peak>
numeric parameter for the peak throughput class
0 network subscribed value
Peak Throughput
Class Peak Throughput
(in octets per second)
1
Up to 1 000 (8 kbit/s)
2
Up to 2 000 (16 kbit/s)
3
Up to 4 000 (32 kbit/s)
4
Up to 8 000 (64 kbit/s)
5
Up to 16 000 (128 kbit/s)
6
Up to 32 000 (256 kbit/s)
7
Up to 64 000 (512 kbit/s)
8
Up to 128 000 (1 024 kbit/s)
9
Up to 256 000 (2 048 kbit/s)
<mean>
numeric parameter for the mean throughput class
0 network subscribed value
Mean Throughput Class Mean Throughput
(in octets per hour)
1
100 (~0.22 bit/s)
2
200 (~0.44 bit/s)
3
500 (~1.11 bit/s)
4
1 000 (~2.2 bit/s)
5
2 000 (~4.4 bit/s)
6
5 000 (~11.1 bit/s)
7
10 000 (~22 bit/s)
8
20 000 (~44 bit/s)
9
50 000 (~111 bit/s)
10
100 000 (~0.22 kbit/s)
11
200 000 (~0.44 kbit/s)
12
500 000 (~1.11 kbit/s)
13
1 000 000 (~2.2 kbit/s)
14
2 000 000 (~4.4 kbit/s)
15
5 000 000 (~11.1 kbit/s)
16
10 000 000 (~22 kbit/s)
17
20 000 000 (~44 kbit/s)
18
50 000 000 (~111 kbit/s)
31
best effort.
Note: If parameters are not defined, the parameter default values depend
on the HLR-stored subscribed default values.
Definitions of parameters in GSM 02.60 and GSM 03.60 paragraph 15.2
“Quality of Service Profile“.
If some of the QoS parameters are omitted, they will keep their current
value (or the default value if not specified so far), e.g.
at+cgqmin?
OK
at+cgqmin=1,0
OK
at+cgqmin?
+CGQMIN:1,0,0,0,0,0
OK
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 156 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
at+cgqmin=1,0,0,0,1
OK
at+cgqmin?
+CGQMIN:1,0,0,0,1,0
OK
at+cgqmin=1,1
OK
at+cgqmin?
+CGQMIN:1,1,0,0,1,0
OK
Response
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Reference
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 157 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
6.1.6 AT+CGQREQ Quality of Service Profile (Requested)
Test command
AT+CGQREG=?
The test command returns values supported as a compound value. If the MT
supports several PDP types, the parameter value ranges for each PDP type
are returned on a separate line.
Response
+CGQREG: <PDP_type>, (list of supported <precedence>s), (list of supported <delay>s), (list of supported <reliability>s), (list of supported
<peak>s), (list of supported <mean>s) [<CR><LF>+CGQREG: ...]
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<PDP_type>
<precedence>
<delay>
<reliability>
<peak>
<mean>
Read command
AT+CGQREG?
String parameter of Packet Data Protocol type
IP
See write command
See write command
See write command
See write command
See write command
The read command returns the current settings for each defined context. If
no requested profile was explicitly specified for a context, simply OK will be
returned, but default values will be used for that context.
Response
+CGQREG: <cid>, <precedence>, <delay>, <reliability>, <peak>, <mean>
[<CR><LF>+CGQREG: ...]
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
<cid>
<precedence>
<delay>
<reliability>
<peak>
<mean>
See write command
See write command
See write command
See write command
See write command
See write command
Write command
This command allows the TE to specify a Quality of Service Profile that is
used when the MT sends an Activate PDP Context Request message to the
AT+CGQREG=
[<cid>[,<precedence> network.
,<delay>[,<reliability>[ The set command specifies a profile for the context identified by the (local)
,<peak>[,<mean>]]]]]] context identification parameter, <cid>.
A special form of the set command, +CGQREQ= <cid> causes the requested profile for context number <cid> to become undefined.
AT&F and ATZ will undefine the QoS profiles of every context which is not
active or not online.
Parameter
<cid>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
numeric PDP Context Identifier; if no cid is specified, nothing
will be changed (neither profile definition nor undefinition)
1
2
Page 158 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
<precedence>
numeric parameter for the precedence class
0 network subscribed value
1 High Priority
Service commitments shall be maintained ahead of
precedence classes 2 and 3
2 Normal priority
Service commitments shall be maintained ahead of
precedence class 3
3 Low priority
Service commitments shall be maintained ahead of
precedence classes 1 and 2
<delay>
numeric parameter for the delay class
0 network subscribed value
SDU size: 128 octets:
Delay Class
Mean Transfer Delay
1
2
3
4
(Predictive)
(Predictive)
(Predictive)
(Best Effort)
<0.5
<5
< 50
Unspecified
SDU size: 1024 octets:
Delay Class
Mean Transfer Delay
95 percentile
Delay
<1.5
< 25
< 250
95 percentile
Delay
<1.5
< 25
< 250
1 (Predictive)
<0.5
2 (Predictive)
<5
3 (Predictive)
< 50
4 (Best Effort) Unspecified
The delay parameter defines theend-to-end transfer delay incurred
in the transmission of SDUs through the GPRS network(s).
<reliability>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
numeric parameter for the reliability class
0 network subscribed value
1 Non real-time traffic, error-sensitive application that
cannot cope with data loss
2 Non real-time traffic, error-sensitive application thatcan cope with infrequent data loss
3 Non real-time traffic, error-sensitive application that
can cope with data loss, GMM/SM, and SMS
4 Real-time traffic, error-sensitive application that can
cope with data loss
5 Real-time traffic, error non-sensitive application that
can cope with data loss
Page 159 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
<peak>
numeric parameter for the peak throughput class
0 network subscribed value
Peak Throughput
Class Peak Throughput
(in octets per second)
1
Up to 1 000 (8 kbit/s).
2
Up to 2 000 (16 kbit/s).
3
Up to 4 000 (32 kbit/s).
4
Up to 8 000 (64 kbit/s).
5
Up to 16 000 (128 kbit/s).
6
Up to 32 000 (256 kbit/s).
7
Up to 64 000 (512 kbit/s).
8
Up to 128 000 (1 024 kbit/s).
9
Up to 256 000 (2 048 kbit/s).
<mean>
numeric parameter for the mean throughput class
0 network subscribed value
Mean Throughput Class
Mean Throughput
(in octets per hour)
1
100 (~0.22 bit/s)
2
200 (~0.44 bit/s)
3
500 (~1.11 bit/s)
4
1 000 (~2.2 bit/s)
5
2 000 (~4.4 bit/s)
6
5 000 (~11.1 bit/s)
7
10 000 (~22 bit/s)
8
20 000 (~44 bit/s)
9
50 000 (~111 bit/s)
10
100 000 (~0.22 kbit/s)
11
200 000 (~0.44 kbit/s)
12
500 000 (~1.11 kbit/s)
13
1 000 000 (~2.2 kbit/s)
14
2 000 000 (~4.4 kbit/s)
15
5 000 000 (~11.1 kbit/s)
16
10 000 000 (~22 kbit/s)
17
20 000 000 (~44 kbit/s)
18
50 000 000 (~111 kbit/s)
31
best effort.
Note: If parameters are not defined, the parameter default values depend on
the HLR-stored subscribed default values.
If some of the QoS parameters are omitted, then they will keep their current
value (or the default value if not specified so far), e.g.
at+cgqreq?
OK
at+cgqreq=1,0
OK
at+cgqreq?
+CGQREQ:1,0,0,0,0,0
OK
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 160 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
at+cgqreq=1,0,0,1
OK
at+cgqreq?
+CGQREQ:1,0,0,1,0,0
OK
at+cgqreq=1,1
OK
at+cgqreq?
+CGQREQ:1,1,0,1,0,0
OK
Definitions of parameters in GSM 02.60 and GSM 03.60 paragraph 15.2
“Quality of Service Profile“.
Response
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Reference
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 161 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
6.1.7 AT+CGSMS Select service for MO SMS messages
Test command
AT+CGSMS=?
The test command lists the services and service preferences which can be
selected with the AT+CGSMS write command.
Response
+CGSMS: (list of supported <service>s
OK
Parameter
See write command
<service>
Read command
AT+CGSMS?
The read command returns the currently selected service or service preference.
Response
+CGSMS: <service>
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
See write command
<service>
Write command
AT+CGSMS=
[<service>]
The write command specifies what service or service preference the MT
shall use when sending MO SMS messages. If parameter <service> is not
given, the current value remains unchanged.
Parameter
<service>
a numeric parameter which indicates the service or service
preference to be used.
0
GPRS
1
circuit switched
2
GPRS preferred (use circuit switched if mobile is not
GPRS attached)
3
circuit switched preferred (use GPRS if circuit switched is
not available)
Response
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Reference
GSM 07.07
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Note:
• Default value is 3 (circuit switched preferred).
• Parameter cannot be stored to user profile (AT&W).
Page 162 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
6.1.8 AT^SGAUTH Set type of authentication for PPP connection
Test command
Response
AT^SGAUTH=?
^SGAUTH: (list of supported <auth>s)
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<auth>
indicates types of supported authentication
0 None
1 PAP
2 CHAP
3 PAP and CHAP
Read command
Response
AT^SGAUTH?
+CGACT: <auth>
OK/ ERROR/ + CME ERROR
Parameter
See test command
Write command
Response
AT^SGAUTH=
<auth>
OK/ ERROR/ + CME ERROR
Parameter
See test command
Reference
Note
Siemens
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 163 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
6.2
Modem compatibility commands to MTs supporting GPRS
This subclause describes how existing AT commands, designed for use with a modem, may be used
to control a GPRS MT. This is to provide backwards compatibility with existing communications software.
6.3
ATD *99# Request GPRS service
Execute command
This command causes the MT to perform whatever actions are necATD*99[*[<called_address>] essary to establish communication between the TE and the external
PDN.
[*[<L2P>][*[<cid>]]]]#
The V.25ter 'D' (Dial) command causes the MT to enter the V.25ter
online data state and, with the TE, to start the specified layer 2 protocol. No further commands may follow on the AT command line. GPRS
attachment and PDP context activation procedures may take place
prior to or during the PDP startup if they have not already been performed using the +CGATT (see Chapter 6.1.1) and +CGACT (see
Chapter 6.1.2) commands. If the context to be used is already activated, it will be deactivated first. This ensures that the right context
parameters will be used (e.g. QoS changes since the last context activation or the called address specified by ATD).
Examples on how to use this command are provided in chapter 6.5.
Response
To confirm acceptance of the command to entering the V.25ter online
data state:
CONNECT
When the layer 2 protocol has terminated, either as a result of an orderly shut down of the PDP or an error, the MT enters V.25ter command state and returns
NO CARRIER
Parameter
<called_address>
IP V4 address in the form w.x.y.z, see chapter “Using the
GPRS dial command ATD“, pg. 169 which identifies the
called party; if it is provided, the MT will automatically set up
a virtual call to the specified address after the context has
been activated. This parameter is currently not used and
needs not be specified.
<L2P>
layer 2 protocol to be used between the TE and MT
PPP or layer2 for PPP protocol
<cid>:
numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context
definition (see +CGDCONT command). If no context is
specified, an internal context 0 with default QoS (network
subscribed) and APN from EEPROM (if there is one) is
used.
1
2
The +CGDCONT, +CGQREQ, etc. commands may be used prior
to set values for cid, PDP type, APN, QoS etc..
Note:
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
ATD is used as a standard V.25ter AT Command, too.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 164 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
6.3.1 ATD *98# Request GPRS IP service
Execute command
ATD*98[*<cid>]#
This command causes the MT to perform whatever actions are necessary to
establish a communication between the TE and the external PDN.
The V.25ter 'D' (Dial) command causes the MT to enter the V.25ter online data
state and, with the TE, to start the layer 2 protocol.
GPRS attachment and PDP context activation procedures may take place prior
to or during the PDP startup if they have not already been performed using the
+CGATT (see Chapter 6.1.1) and +CGACT (see Chapter 6.1.2) commands. If
the context to be used is already activated, it will be deactivated first. This ensures that the right context parameters will be used (e.g. QoS changes since
the last context activation).
Note: An example of how to use this command can be seen in chapter 6.5
Response
To confirm acceptance of the command to entering the V.25ter online data
state:
CONNECT
When the layer 2 protocol has terminated, either as a result of an orderly shut
down of the PDP or an error, the MT enters V.25ter command state and return
NO CARRIER
Parameter
<cid>:
numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition
(see +CGDCONT command). If no context is specified, an internal
context 0 with default QoS (network subscribed) and APN from
EEPROM (if there is one) is used.
1
2
The +CGDCONT, +CGQREQ, etc. commands may be used prior to set
values for cid, PDP type, APN, QoS etc..
Note:
Reference
Note:
GSM 07.07
ATD is used as a standard V.25ter AT-Command, too.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 165 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
6.3.2 ATH Manual rejection of a network request for PDP context activation
Execute command
Response
ATH
The V.25ter 'H' or 'H0' (On-hook) command may be used to reject a network
request for PDP context activation announced by the unsolicited result code
RING
or
+CRING: GPRS <PDP_type>,<PDP_addr>
The MT responds with
OK
Reference
Note
GSM 07.07
• In contrast to GSM 07.07 it is possible to cancel a connection with ATH after
a break. This is done for compatibility reasons due to the “dial-up network“
(“DFÜ-Netzwerk“) drivers of Microsoftã Windowsâ.
• ATH is used as a standard V.25ter AT Command, too. See Chapter 2.12.
Using ATH while GPRS is active (PDP context is activated or online):
• CAUTION: The execution of ATH cancels an active PDP context. This takes
effect no matter whether ATH was used to end a voice or data (CSD) call, to
manually reject a network requested PDP context activation as described
above or to terminate a call on one of the virtual channels in Multiplex mode.
The context deactivation can be avoided by terminating a current call with
AT+CHLD=1 instead of ATH. See Chapter 4.16 for AT+CHLD.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 166 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
6.4
Using GPRS AT commands (examples)
6.4.1 Miscellaneous AT commands
Defining and using a Context Definition Id (CID):
Every time a CID is used as a parameter for a GPRS command the CID has to be defined before by
the AT+CGDCONT command. To get the parameter of a CID use the AT+CGDCONT read option. If
the response of ‘AT+CGDCONT?’ is OK only, there is no CID defined.
AT+CGDCONT?
OK
// there is no CID defined
All parameters of the CID are initiated by NULL or not present values and the CID itself is set to be
undefined. To define a CID use the AT+CGDCONT Command with at least one CID parameter. At the
moment the mobile supports CID 1 and CID 2 by using the AT+CGDCONT command.
Examples:
AT+CGDCONT=1,IP
OK
// defines CID 1and sets the PDP type to IP
// access point name and IP address aren't set
AT+CGDCONT=2,IP, "internet.t-d1.gprs", 111.222.123.234
OK
// defines CID 2 ans sets PDP type, APN and IP addr
A following read command will respond
AT+CGDCONT?
+CGDCONT:1,IP
+CGDCONT:2,IP," internet.t-d1.gprs",111.222.123.234
OK
AT+CGDCONT=1
OK
// sets the CID 1 to be undefined
A following read command will respond
AT+CGDCONT?
+CGDCONT:2,IP, "internet.t-d1.gprs",111.222.123.234
OK
Quality of Service (QoS) is a special parameter of a CID which consists of several parameters itself.
The QoS consists of
• the precedence class
• the delay class
• the reliability class
• the peak throughput class
• the mean throughput class
and is devided in "requested QoS" and "minimum acceptable QoS".
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 167 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
All parameters of the QoS are initiated by default to the "network subscribed value (= 0)" but the QoS
itself is set to be undefined. To define a QoS use the AT+CGQREQ or AT+CGQMIN command.
Examples:
AT+CGQREQ=1,2
OK
// overwrites the precedence class of QoS of CID 1 and sets
// the QoS of CID 1 to be present
A following read command will response
AT+CGQREQ?
+CGQREQ: 1,2,0,0,0,0
OK
// all QoS values of CID 1 are set to network subscribed
// except precedence class which is set to 2
AT+CGQREQ=1
OK
// set the QoS of CID 1 to not present
Once defined, the CID it can be activated. To activate a CID use
AT+CGACT=1,2
OK
// activate CID 2
If the CID is already active, the mobile responses OK at once.
If no CID is given, all defined CIDs will be activated by
AT+CGACT=
// NO CID and NO STATE given
OK
// all defined CIDs will be activated
If no CID is defined the mobile responses +CME ERROR: invalid index
Remark: If the mobile is NOT attached by AT+CGATT=1 before activating, the attach is automatically
done by the AT+CGACT command.
After defining and activating a CID it may be used to get online by
AT+CGDATA=PPP,1
CONNECT
// the mobile is connected using the parameters of CID 1
AT+CDATA=
CONNECT
// the mobile is connected using default parameter
The mobile supports Layer 2 Protocol (L2P) PPP only.
Remark: If the mobile is NOT attached by AT+CGATT=1 and the CID is NOT activated before connecting, attaching and activating is automatically done by the AT+CGDATA command.
Some providers (e.g. D2 or E-Plus) require to use an APN to establish a GPRS connection. So if you
use the Microsoft Windows Dial-Up Network and ATD*9... to connect to GPRS you must provide the
context definition as part of the modem definition (Modem properties/Connection/Advanced.../Extra
settings). As an alternative, you can define and activate the context in a terminal program (e.g. Microsoft Hyperterminal) and then use the Dial-Up Network to send only the ATD command.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 168 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
6.5
Using the GPRS dial command ATD
In addition to the GPRS AT Commands you can use the "D" command to dial into to the GPRS network.
There are two GPRS Service Codes for the ATD Command: Values 98 and 99.
Examples:
ATD*99#
CONNECT
// establish a connection by service code 99
ATD*99*123.124.125.126*PPP*1#
CONNECT
// establish a connection by service code 99, IP address 123…
//and L2P = PPP and using CID 1.
// The CID has to be defined by AT+CGDCONT
ATD*99**PPP#
CONNECT
// establish a connection by service code 99 and L2P = PPP
ATD*99***1#
CONNECT
// establish a connection by service code 99 and using CID 1
ATD*99**PPP*1#
CONNECT
ATD*98#
CONNECT
ATD*98*1#
CONNECT
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
// establish a connection by service code 99 and L2P = PPP and
// using CID 1. The CID has to be defined by AT+CGDCONT
// establish an IP connection by service code 98
// establish an IP connection by service code 98 using CID 1
// The CID has to be defined by AT+CGDCONT
Page 169 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
7 AT Commands for SIM Application Toolkit (GSM 11.14)
SIM Application Toolkit (SAT) is a technology that lets the SIM card execute a great variety of additional applications. Conventionally, SIM cards are intended to store user specific data, such as phonebooks, secure user identification codes and messages, but they can also hold a lot of value-added
mobile applications.
The SAT functionality integrated in MC35 and MC35T allows to execute network specific applications
implemented on the SIM card. Typical examples are online banking and information services.
The commands exchanged between SAT and the SIM application fall into two categories:
• Proactive commands – sent from the SIM application to the module’s SAT, e.g. DISPLAY TEXT.
• Envelope commands – sent from the module's SAT to the SIM application, e.g. MENU SELECTION.
The SAT implementation supports SAT class 3, GSM 11.14 Release 98, no support of letter classes.
GSM 11.14 describes Proactive and Envelope Commands in detail.
Note:
To give you an idea, this chapter contains a brief overview of the AT commands and responses related to the SIM Application Toolkit (SAT) implementation. The full set of SAT specific AT commands and a detailed descripton of the SAT functions is provided in a separate
documentation: the "MC35 Remote-SAT User's Guide" supplied with MC35 and MC35 Terminal. Please contact your local dealer or Siemens AG for details.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 170 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
7.1
AT^SSTA Remote-SAT Interface Activation
Test command
Response
AT^SSTA=?
^SSTA:(list of supported <state>s), (list of supported <alphabet>s)
Parameter description see below.
Read command
AT^SSTA?
The read command can be used to request the current operating status and the
used alphabet of the Remote-SAT interface.
Response
^SSTA:<state>,<alphabet>,<allowedInstance>,<SatProfile>
<state>
device state:
<allowedInstance>
0
SAT is already used on an other instance (logical channel in
case of the multiplex protocol). Only test and read commands can be used.
1
SAT may be started on this instance via the write version of
this command (see below).
<SatProfile>
SAT profile according to GSM 11.14.
The profile tells the SIM application which features are
supported by the SIM Application Toolkit implemented by the
ME.
Write command
AT^SSTA=
<mode>
[,<Alphabet>]
The write command is used to activate the AT command interface to the SIM
Application Toolkit in the ME, and must be issued after every power on. However, removing and inserting the SIM does not affect the activation status.
SAT commands which are not using the AT interface (non MMI related SAT
commands , e.g. PROVIDE LOCAL INFORMATION) may be executed without
activating Remote-SAT.
Response
OK
Parameter
<mode>
1
Activate Remote-SAT (to enter state IDLE)
0
ANSI character set
Input of a character requests one byte , e.g. “Y”.
1
UCS2
To display the 16 bit value of characters represented in
UCS2 alphabet a 4 byte string is required, e.g. “0059” is
coding the character “Y”. For details please refer to ISO/IEC
10646.
<Alphabet>
Reference
Note
Siemens
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 171 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
7.2
^SSTN Remote-SAT Notification
Proactive
Commands
Every time the SIM application issues a proactive command, via the ME, the TA
will receive a notification. This indicates the type of proactive command issued.
AT^SSTGI must then be used by the TA to request the parameters of the proactive command from the ME.
Upon receiving the ^SSTGI response from the ME, the TA must send AT^SSTR
to confirm the execution of the proactive command and provide any required user
response, e.g. selected menu item.
Unsolicited result code
^SSTN: <cmdType>
Parameters
<cmdType>
Terminate
Proactive
Command
Proactive command ID
When the SIM application has issued a proactive command, via the ME, to the
TA, it is possible that this command must be terminated. The ^SSTN Unsolicited
Result Code is sent but with a different command type to indicate the termination
of the specified command.
Unsolicited result code
^SSTN: <cmdTerminateValue>
Parameters
<cmdTerminateValue>
SIM Application returns to
main menu
Terminate proactive command ID
Notification to the TA when the SIM Application has finished a command cycle
and again enters its main menue.
This URC should be used to open this menue on the sreen.
Unsolicited result code
^SSTN: <254>
Reference
Note
Siemens
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 172 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
7.3
AT^SSTGI Remote-SAT Get Information
Test command
Response
AT^SSTGI=?
^SSTGI:(list of supported <state>s), (list of supported <cmdType>s)
OK
Read command
Response
AT^SSTGI?
^SSTGI: <state>, <cmdType>
OK
Parameters
<state>
Remote-SAT interface states (refer to AT^SSTA)
<cmdType> Ongoing Proactive Command
Write command
AT^SSTGI=
<cmdType>
Reference
Regularly this Write command is used upon receipt of an unsolicited result code
^SSTN:<cmdType>.
The TA is expected to acknowledge the ^SSTGI response with AT^SSTR to
confirm that the proactive command has been executed.
AT^SSTR will also provide any user information, e.g. a selected menu item.
The command type value is returned to the ME to identify which ^SSTN is being
responded to.
Note
Siemens
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 173 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
7.4
AT^SSTR Remote-SAT Response
Test command
Response
AT^SSTR=?
^SSTR:(list of supported <state>s), (list of supported <cmdType>s)
OK
Read command
Response
AT^SSTR?
^SSTR: <state>, <cmdType>
OK
Parameters
Write command
AT^SSTR=
<cmdType>,
<status>
[,<itemId>]
[,<inputString>]
Reference
<state>
Remote-SAT interface state
<cmdType>
Ongoing Proactive Command
The TA is expected to acknowledge the ^SSTGI response with AT^SSTR to
confirm
that
the
proactive
command
has
been
executed.
AT^SSTR will also provide any user information, e.g. a selected menu item.
Response
OK
Parameters
<cmdType>
Number related to Proactive command or event type
<status>
Command status return regarding the type of action that has
taken place, e.g. action performed by the user.
<itemId>
id of menu item selected by user
<inputString>
string response entered by user
Note
Siemens
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 174 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8 Siemens defined AT commands for enhanced functions
Self-defined commands do not have to be implemented in accordance with the official syntax. The
“+C” string can therefore be replaced by “^S” (“^” = 0x5E). If a self-defined command with the same
syntax will be included in future in the GSM recommendations, the command can be addressed with
both strings.
8.1
AT+CXXCID Display card ID (identical to AT^SCID)
Test command
Response
AT+CXXCID=?
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
Execute command
Response
AT+CXXCID
TA returns the card identification number in SIM (SIM file EF ICCID, see
GSM 11.11 Chap.10.1.1) as string type.
See ^SCID
Parameter
See ^SCID
Reference
Note
Siemens
See also GSM Engine A1: ^SCID
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 175 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.2
AT^MONI Monitor idle mode and dedicated mode
Test command
Response
^MONI: (list of supported < period >s) OK
This command can be used to retrieve information of the serving/dedicated cell
AT^MONI[=<pe automatically every n seconds. It is cancelled by any character sent to serial port
except if autobauding is enabled (+IPR=0). Then type character ´a´ to abort.
riod>]
AT^MONI=?
Write command
Note:
The two header lines (see below) are output after every ten data lines.
Response
See execute command
Parameter
1 – 254
<period>
Execute command
Display period in seconds
This command can be used to retrieve the cell parameters of the serving/dedicated
cell on request.
AT^MONI
Note:
The length of following output lines exceeds 80 characters. Therefore a terminal
program may draw a carriage return on a screen. However, this is not part of the
response.
Response (Examples)
a) ME is camping on a cell:
Serving Cell
chann rs dBm PLMN LAC cell NCC BCC PWR RXLev
1013 21 -71 00101 1001 0103
7
7 33 -105
I Dedicated channel
C1 I chann TS timAdv PWR
33 I
No connection
dBm Q ChMod
b) ME is camping on a cell but searching for a better cell (cell reselection)
Serving Cell
I Dedicated channel
chann rs dBm PLMN LAC cell NCC BCC PWR RXLev C1 I chann TS timAdv PWR
1013
4 –106 00101 1001 0103
7
7 33 -105 -35 I
in Reselecting
dBm Q ChMod
c) ME is not camping on a cell, could not (yet) find a valid C0 bearer
Serving Cell
chann rs dBm
LAC cell NCC BCC PWR RXLev
I Dedicated channel
C1 I chann TS timAdv PWR
dBm Q ChMod
Serving Cell
chann rs dBm PLMN LAC cell NCC BCC PWR RXLev
1013 19 -76 00101 1001 0103
7
7 33 -105
I Dedicated channel
C1 I chann TS timAdv PWR
33 I 1015
1
0
5
dBm Q ChMod
-76 0 S_HR
PLMN
ME is connected:
Parameters
Serving Cell:
chann
traffic channel number
rs
RSSI value 0 – 63 (RSSI = Received signal strength indication)
dBm
receiving level in dBm
PLMN
PLMN ID code
LAC
location area code, see note below.
cell
Cell ID, see note below.
NCC
PLMN colour code
BCC
Base Station colour code
PWR
maximal power level used on RACH channel
RXLev
minimal receiving level (in dBm) to allow registration
C1
coefficient for base station selection
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 176 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Dedicated channel:
chann
traffic channel number
Note: <chann> = h indicates frequency hopping.
TS
timeslot no.
timAdv
timing advance in bits
PWR
current power level
dBm
receiving level in dBm
Q
receiving quality (0–7)
ChMod
channel mode (S_HR: Half rate, S_FR: Full rate, S_EFR: Enhanced Full
Rate)
Reference
Note
Siemens
• If the radio cell changes during a connection, the parameters LAC, Cell, NCC
BCC, PWR and RXLev of the ‘Serving Cell’ part will not be updated (see also
+CREG, pg 113).
• If the BS supports frequency hopping during a connection, the dedicated channel (parameter chann) is not stable. This mode is indicated by chann = ‘h’.
• The cell information can be issued in the form of unsolicited result codes (related to <period>), or it can be queried directly using the Execute command
AT^MONI. In the first case, the ME activates its RING line (Logic “1”) for one
second to send the URC to the connected application. In the second case, the
RING line does not change.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 177 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.3
AT^MONP Monitor neighbour cells
Test command
Response
AT^MONP=?
^MONP: (list of supported < period >s) OK
Write command
This command can be used to retrieve information of up to six neighbour
cells automatically every n seconds. It is cancelled by any character sent
to the serial port except if autobauding is enabled (+IPR=0). Then type
character ´a´ to abort.
AT^MONP=[<period>]
Response
See execute command
Parameter
<period>
Execute command
AT^MONP
1 – 254
Display period in seconds
This command can be used to obtain information of up to six neighbour
cells on request.
Response (Example)
Parameter:
Chann
Channel number
rs
RSSI value 0 – 63 (RSSI = Received signal strength indication)
dBm
Receiving level in dBm
PLMN
PLMN ID code
BCC
Base Station colour code
C1
coefficient for base station selection
C2
coefficient for base station selection
Reference
Note
Siemens
• The cell information can be issued in the form of unsolicited result
codes (related to <period>), or it can be queried directly using the Execute command AT^MONI. In the first case, the ME activates its RING
line (Logic “0”) for one second to send the URC to the connected application. In the second case, the RING line does not change.
• Due to the fact that not all necessary information of the neighbour cells
can be decoded during the connection, there are several constraints to
be considered:
- Only neighbour cells of the serving cell the MS was camping on
during call setup will be further updated, as long as they are visible.
- New neighbour cells that have been added to the list (e.g. in result
of a handover), are not made visibile via the AT^MONP command
until the connection is released.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 178 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.4
AT^SACM Advice of charge and query of ACM and ACMmax
Test command
Response
AT^SACM=?
^SACM: (list of supported <n>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Execute command
AT^SACM
The execute command can be used to query the current mode of the Advice of
Charge supplementary service, the SIM values of the accumulated call meter
(ACM) and accumulated call meter maximum (ACMmax).
Response
^SACM: <n>,<acm>,<acm_max> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<n>
See write command
<acm>
ACM, string type; three bytes of the current ACM value in hexadecimal format (e.g. “00001E” indicates decimal value 30) 000000–
FFFFFF
<acm_max> ACMmax, string type; three bytes of the max. ACM value in hexadecimal format (e.g. “00001E” indicates decimal value 30) 000000 disable ACMmax feature 000001-FFFFFF
<ccm>
Write command
AT^SACM=<n>
string type; three bytes of the current CCM value in hexadecimal format (e.g. “00001E” indicates decimal value 30); bytes are coded in
the same way as ACMmax value in the SIM 000000-FFFFFF
The write command enables or disables the presentation of unsolicited result to
report the call charges.
Response
OK or if error is related to ME functionality: +CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<n>
0
suppress unsolicited result code
1
display unsolicited result code
When you power down or reset the ME with AT+CFUN=1,1 the URC
presentation mode will be reset to its default. To benefit from the
URC it is recommended to have the setting included in the user profile saved with AT&W, or to select <n>=1 every time you reboot the
ME.
Unsolicited result code
When activated, an unsolicited result code is sent when the CCM value changes,
but not more often than every 10 seconds
+CCCM: <ccm>
Reference
Note
Siemens
See also GSM07.07: AT+CACM, AT+CAMM, AT+CAOC
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 179 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.5
AT^SBC Battery charging / discharging and charge control
This chapter is only applicable to MC35, it is not intended for MC35 Terminal.
Responses returned by the AT^SBC command vary with the operating mode of the ME:
Normal mode:
ME is switched on by Ignition pin and running the SLEEP, IDLE,
TALK or DATA mode. Charger is not connected. AT^SBC can be
used to query the battery capacity and the power consumption of
ME and application (if value of application was specified before as
<current>).
Normal mode + charging:
Allows charging while ME is switched on by Ignition pin and running
the SLEEP, IDLE, TALK or DATA mode. AT^SBC returns charger
status and power consumption of ME / application. Battery capacity
is not available.
Charge-only mode:
Allows charging while ME is detached from GSM network. When
started, the mode is indicated by the URC "^SYSSTART CHARGEONLY MODE". AT^SBC returns charger status and power consumption of ME / application. Percentage of battery capacity is not
available. In Charge-only mode a limited number of AT commands is
accessible (see Table 9). There are several ways to activate the
Charge-only mode:
a) from Power Down mode: Connect charger while ME was powered
down with AT^SMSO
b) from Normal mode: Connect charger, then enter AT^SMSO.
Alarm mode:
No charging functionality, i.e. charging does not start even though
the charger connects to the POWER lines. Battery parameters are
not available.
Charging begins once the charger connects to the POWER pins of the ZIF connector (except for the
Alarm mode). Please refer to the [1] ("Hardware Interface Description") supplied with your GSM engine and the Application Note "Charging the Battery Pack" for details on the charging process.
Test command
Response
AT^SBC=?
^SBC: (list of supported <bcs>s),(list of supported <bcl>s),<mpc> module power
consumption
Defined values
<bcs>
0
No charging adapter is connected
<bcl>
1
Charging adapter is connected
2
Charging adapter is connected, charging in progress
3
Charging adapter is connected, charging has finished
4
Charging error, charging is interrupted
5
False charging temperature, charging is interrupted while
temperature is beyond allowed range
Battery capacity
0, 20, 40, 60, 80, 100 percent of remaining capacity (6 steps)
0 indicates that either the battery is exhausted or the capacity value
is not available
<mpc>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Average power consumption:
Value (0...5000) of average power consumption (mean value over a
couple of seconds) in mA. See read and write command for details.
Page 180 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Read command
Response
AT^SBC?
^SBC: <bcs>,<bcl>,<mpc>
<bcs>
Connection status of battery pack
<bcl>
Battery charge level
While charging is in progress (charging adapter connected) the
battery capacity is not available. Consequently, parameter <bcl>=0.
To query the battery capacity disconnect the charger.
<mpc>
Average power consumption
<mpc> is obtained from the ME's power consumption, plus the value
you have specified for the application by using the write command
AT^SBC=<current>. Remember that the ME's power consumption
varies with its operating mode (IDLE, TALK, DATA, GPRS/DATA)
and the power level.
If <current> was not yet specified and no battery pack NTC is
detected <mpc> returns only the module's present power
consumption.
If <current> was not yet specified, but the NTC of the connected
battery pack is detected, an offset value of 200mA will, by default, be
added. 200mA is an estimated value which represents the power
consumption of a typical external application. Drawn from practical
experience it serves as a precaution to ensure proper charging in
case you have not entered <current>. It is strongly recommended
that you enter the correct power consumption of your application as
described below.
Note: If the battery does not incorporate an NTC, or the battery and
the NTC are not compliant with the requirements specified in [1], the
battery cannot be detected by the ME.
Write command
AT^SBC=
<current>
Use the write command to specify the power consumption of your external application. This information enables the ME to calculate the average power consumption <mpc> and to properly control the charging process. If the value is not
correct the entire charging process may be affected. Resulting problems may be
wrong responses to the AT^SBC read command, overcharging, or the battery
does not reach full capacity.
The write command registers the serial port as the output channel for unsolicited
result codes related to charging.
When the ME is powered down or reset, the value of <current> is restored to its
default. This affects the charging control and disables the presentation of unsolicited result codes. Therefore, the parameter should be set every time when
needed after rebooting the ME.
Response
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<current>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Enter the current consumption of your application in mA (0...5000). If
used, the current provided over the by 2.9V VDD pin of the ZIF interface (maximum 70mA) must be added, too.
Page 181 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Unsolicited result code
^SBC: Undervoltage
The message will be reported, for example, when you attempt to set up a call
while the voltage is close to the critical limit and further power loss is caused during the transmit burst. To remind you that the battery needs to be charged soon,
the URC appears several times before the module switches off. In this case, the
battery capacity is still sufficient to set up a short call.
When the module is in IDLE mode it takes typically one minute to deregister from
the network and to switch off.
Undervoltage protection in mains operated applications:
• The undervoltage protection is also efficient in applications which are not battery operated, i.e. in applications where the ACCU_TEMP pin is not connected. To use this feature it is sufficient to issue the write command which
automatically enables the presentation of URCs. You do not need to specify
<current>. Please note, that in contrast to battery powered applications, the
ME will present the undervoltage URC only once and will then switch off without sending any further messages.
Reference
Note
Siemens
• If Multiplex mode is active, any virtual channel can be used to enter the write
command and to specify <current>. The undervoltage URC, however, appears
simultaneously on all three channels.
• The URC "^SYSSTART CHARGE-ONLY MODE" is indicated automatically
when the engine enters this mode (except when autobauding is active). Unlike
the undervoltage URC, it cannot be disabled or enabled by the user.
Table 9: Summary of AT commands available in Charge-only and Alarm mode
AT command
AT+CALA
AT+CCLK
AT^SBC
AT^SCTM
AT^SMSO
Use
Set alarm time
Set date and time of RTC
Monitor charging process
Note: While charging is in progress, no battery parameters are available. To query
the battery capacity disconnect the charger. If the charger connects externally to
the host device no charging parameters are transferred to the module. In this
case, the command cannot be used.
Query temperature of GSM engine, enable or disable URCs
Power down GSM engine
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 182 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.6
AT^SCID Display SIM card identification number
Test command
Response
AT^SCID=?
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
Execute command
Response
AT^SCID
TA returns the identification number of the SIM card (see GSM 11.11 Chapter
10.1.1).
^SCID: <cid> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<cid>
Reference
string type: card identification number of SIM card
Note
Siemens
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 183 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.7
AT^SCKS Set SIM connection presentation mode and query SIM connection status
Test command
Response
AT^SCKS=?
^SCKS: (list of supported <n>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT^SCKS?
TA returns the URC presentation mode and the status of the SIM card connection.
^SCKS: <n>, <m> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT^SCKS=<n>
TA enables or disables the presentation of URCs to report whether or not the SIM
card is connected.
When the ME is powered down or reset with AT+CFUN=1,1 the presentation
mode <n> will not be restored to ist default. To benefit from the URCs, it is recommended to have the setting <n>=1 included in the user profile saved with
AT&W, or activate the setting every time you reboot the ME.
OK
Parameter
<n>
0 Suppress unsolicited result codes
1 Output unsolicited result codes
<m>
0 No card
1 Card in card reader
Unsolicited result code
When the status "SIM connected" has changed, an unsolicited result code is sent
to the TE.
^SCKS: <m>
Parameter
See write command
Reference
Note
Siemens
Note that the connection status of <m>reflects only the status of the card holder
tray. In an empty SIM card tray is inserted, two URCs will be output, indicating the
status 1 and 0 (= SIM card connected and not connected).
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 184 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.8
AT^SCNI List Call Number Information
Test command
Response
AT^SCNI=?
OK
Execute command
Response
AT^SCNI
TA returns a list of current calls of ME.
[^SCNI: <id1>[,<cs>[,<number>,<type>]]]
[^SCNI: <id2>[,<cs>[,<number>,<type>]]]
[...] OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<idx>
1–7
integer type; call identification number as described in GSM
02.30[19] subclause 4.5.5.1; this number can be used in
+CHLD command operations
<cs>
Call status of respective call number (first parameter)
0
call hold
1
call in progress
2
Waiting call
<number>
string type phone number in format specified by <type>
<type>
type of address octet in integer format; 145 when dialling string
includes international access code character “+”, otherwise 129
Reference
Note
Siemens
See also GSM 07.07: AT+CLCC
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 185 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.9
AT^SCTM Set critical operating temperature presentation mode or
query temperature
Use this command to monitor the temperature range of the module and the battery. The write command enables or disables the presentation of URCs to report critical temperature limits.
CAUTION: During the first 15 seconds after start-up, the module operates in an automatic report
mode: URCs can be always displayed regardless of the selected mode <n>.
Test command
Response
AT^SCTM=?
^SCTM: (list of supported <n>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT^SCTM?
TA returns the URC presentation mode and information about the current temperature range of the module (not of the battery).
^SCTM: <n>, <m> OK
Parameters
<n>
0 Presentation of URCs is disabled (except for <m> equal to –2 or +2).
1 Presentation of URCs is enabled.
<m>
-2 Below lowest temperature limit (causes immediate switch-off)
-1 Below low temperature alert limit
0 Normal operating temperature
1 Above upper temperature alert limit
2 Above uppermost temperature limit (causes immediate switch-off)
Write command
AT^SCTM=<n>
Select <n> to enable or disable the presentation of the URCs. Please note that the
setting will not be stored upon Power Down, i.e. after restart or reset, the default
level 0 will be restored. To benefit from the URCs <n>=1 needs to be selected
every time you reboot the GSM engine.
Response
OK
Parameters
<n>
0
Suppress URCs (except for <m> equal to –2 or +2)
1
Enable presentation of URCs.
Please see notes below for further details.
Unsolicited result code
URCs will be automatically sent to the TA when the temperature reaches or exceeds the critical level, or when it is back to normal.
^SCTM_A: <m>
^SCTM_B: <m>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
for battery (accumulator) temperature
for module (board) temperature
Page 186 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Reference
Note
Siemens
Important:
• Please refer to the "Hardware Inferface Description" supplied with your GSM
engine for specifications on critical temperature ranges.
• To avoid damage the module will shut down once the critical temperature is
exceeded. The procedure is equivalent to the power-down initiated with
AT^SMSO.
• URCs indicating the alert level "1" or "-1" are intended to enable the user to
take appropriate precautions, such as protect the module or battery from exposure to extreme conditions, or save or back up data etc. The presentation of "1"
or "-1" URCs depends on the settings selected with the write command:
If <n>=0: Presentation is enabled for 15 s time after the module was switched
on. After 15 s operation, the presentation will be disabled, i.e. no URCs will be
generated.
If <n>= 1: Presentation of "1" or "-1" URCs is always enabled.
• Level "2" or "-2" URCs are followed by immediate shutdown. The presentation
of these URCs is always enabled, i.e. they will be output even though the factory setting AT^SCTMC=0 was never changed.
Examples
URCs issued when the operating temperature is out of range:
Example
^SCTM_A: 1
Caution: Battery close to overtemperature limit.
^SCTM_A: 2
Alert: Battery above overtemperature limit. Engine switches off.
^SCTM_B: 1
Caution: Engine close to overtemperature limit.
^SCTM_B: 2
Alert: Engine is above overtemperature limit and switches off.
^SCTM_A: -1
Caution: Battery close to undertemperature limit.
^SCTM_A: -2
Alert: Battery below undertemperature limit. Engine switches
off.
^SCTM_B: -1
Caution: Engine close to undertemperature limit.
^SCTM_B: -2
Alert: Engine is below undertemperature limit and switches off.
URCs issued when the temperature is back to normal (URC is output once):
^SCTM_A: 0
Battery temperature back to normal temperature.
^SCTM_B: 0
Engine back to normal temperature
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 187 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.10 AT^SDLD Delete the “last number redial“ memory
Test command
Response
AT^SDLD=?
OK
Execute command
The execute command deletes all numbers stored in the LD memory.
AT^SDLD
Response
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Reference
Note
Siemens
8.11 AT^SHOM Display Homezone
Test command
Response
AT^SHOM=?
OK
Parameter
See execute command
Execute command
Response
AT^SHOM
TA returns homezone state
^SHOM: <homezonestate> OK
Parameters
<homezonestate>
Reference
0
ME is out of Homezone
1
ME is within the Homezone
Note
Siemens
8.12 AT^SLCD Display Last Call Duration
Test command
Response
AT^SLCD=?
OK
Parameter
See execute command
Execute command
Response
AT^SLCD
TA returns last call duration or current call duration
^SLCD: <time> OK
Parameter
<time>
Reference
string type value; format is "hh:mm:ss", where characters indicate hours,
minutes, seconds; e.g. 22:10:00 “22:10:00",
max values are 9999:59:59
Note
Siemens
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 188 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.13 AT^SLCK Facility lock
Test command
Response
AT^SLCK=?
^SLCK: (list of supported <fac>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT^SLCK=
<fac>,<mode>
[,<passwd>
[,<class>]]
This command is used to lock, unlock or interrogate a ME or a network facility
<fac>.
The command can be aborted while network facilities are being set or interrogated.
If <mode><>2 and command is successful
OK
If <mode>=2 and command successful
^SLCK: <status>[,<class1>[<CR><LF>
^SLCK: <status>, class2....]] OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<fac> Phone security locks set by user / provider
“PS” Phone locked to SIM card (phone code). ME requests password
when other than current SIM card inserted; ME may remember
certain number of previously used cards thus not requiring password when they are inserted.
“SC” SIM (lock SIM cards). SIM requests password upon ME power-up
and when this lock command issued.
“FD” SIM fixed dialling memory: If the mobile is locked to FD, only the
numbers stored to the FD memory can be dialled (up to 7 numbers). If PIN2 authentication has not been performed during the current session, PIN2 is required as <passwd>.
"CS" Keypad lock (not supported since keypad cannot be connected)
Supplementary Service: Call barring
“AO” BAOC (Bar All Outgoing Calls)
“OI” BOIC (Bar Outgoing International Calls)
“OX” BOIC-exHC (Bar Outgoing International Calls except to Home
Country)
“AI” BAIC (Bar All Incoming Calls)
“IR” BIC-Roam (Bar Incoming Calls when Roaming outside the home
country)
“AB” All Barring services (applicable only for <mode>=0)
“AG” All outGoing barring services (applicable only for <mode>=0)
“AC” All inComing barring services (applicable only for <mode>=0)
Factory set facility locks:
“PF” lock Phone to the very First SIM card
“PN” Network Personalisation
“PU” Network subset Personalisation
“PP” Service Provider Personalisation
“PC” Corporate Personalisation
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 189 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
<mode> 0 unlock
1 lock
2 query status
<passwd> password
<class> sum of integers each representing a <class> of information:
1 voice
2 data
4 fax
7 sum of the integers 1, 2 and 4. Call barring for voice, data and fax.
8 short message service
<status> 0 off
1 on
Reference
Note
Siemens
See also specification of AT+CLCK in GSM 07.07 and further details in Chapter
4.21.
8.14 AT^SMGL List SMS messages from preferred storage
Test command
Response
AT^SMGL=?
See write command + CMGL
Parameters
See command +CMGL
Execute/Write
command
AT^SMGL
[=<stat>]
Response
TA returns messages with status value <stat> from message storage <mem1> to
the TE. The status of the messages is u n c h a n g e d (unread remains unread).
Otherwise: See command +CMGL
Parameters
See command +CMGL
Reference
Note
Siemens
See also GSM 07.05: +CMGL
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 190 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.15 AT^SMGO Set or query SMS overflow presentation mode or query SMS
overflow
Test command
Response
AT^SMGO=?
^SGMO: (list of supported <n>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT^SMGO?
TA returns overflow presentation mode and SMS overflow status
^SGMO: <n>,<mode> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT^SMGO=<n> TA sets overflow presentation mode
OK
Parameter
<n>
SMS overflow presentation mode
0 disable (default)
1 enable
<mode> SMS overflow status
0
space available
1
SMS buffer full (buffer for received short messages is <mem3>. See
AT+CPMS in Chapter 5.11)
2
Buffer full and new message waiting in SC for delivery to ME
Unsolicited result code
When the status SIM overflow changes, an unsolicited result code is sent to TE
^SMGO: <mode>
Parameter
See write command
Reference
Note
Siemens
• Indication during data transfer via break (100ms).
• Incoming Class 1 short messages (ME specific) will be preferably stored to
“ME” and may be transferred to the “SM” storage if “ME” is used up. Incoming
Class 2 messages (SIM specific) will be placed to the “SM” storage only.
If messages with different classes are received, the ^SMGO: 2 indication may
be presented, without prior indication of ^SMGO: 1. The indication ^SMGO: 1
means that both buffers ("ME" and "SM") are full. See also Chapter 5.11.
• For more information regarding SIM and ME specific message classes refer to
<dcs> and the following specifications: GSM 03.38 and 3GPP TS 23.038.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 191 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.16 AT^SMSO Switch off mobile station
Test command
Response
AT^SMSO=?
OK
Execute command
Response
AT^SMSO
^SMSO: MS OFF OK
Device will be switched off (power down mode)
Reference
Note
Siemens
Do not send any command after this command
8.17 AT^SMGR Read SMS message without set to REC READ
Test command
Response
AT^SMGR=?
OK
Execute command
Parameter
AT^SMGR=
<index>
See AT+CMGR
Reference
Note
GSM 07.05
The AT^SMGR command is a specific Siemens command with the same syntax as “AT+CMGR Read SMS message”. The only difference is that the SMS
Message, which has REC_UNREAD status, is not overwritten to REC_READ.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 192 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.18 AT^SM20 Set M20 Compatibility
Test command
Response
AT^SM20=?
OK
Read command
Response
AT^SM20?
^SM20: <n>,<m>
OK
Parameters
See write command
Write command
Response
AT^SM20=<n>
M20 is an earlier, widely used SIEMENS GSM engine. The AT^SM20 command controls the behaviour of the ATD and AT+CMGW commands as described below. Please note that the AT^SM20 command has no effect on any
other features and is not intended to adjust other differences between M20 and
MC35.
OK
Parameters
<n>
<m>
Reference
Execution of the ATD command during voice calls
0
Compatible to x35 mobiles.
If this mode is active, TA returns OK when dialling was
completed.
1
Compatible to M20.
If the M20 mode is active, TA returns OK once the call is
successfully set up.
Issuing any command before TA returns OK will cancel the
call setup.
Execution of AT+CMGW command (writing SMS to memory)
0
Compatible to x35 mobiles.
If this mode is active, TA returns +CMS ERROR: <err>
when writing of SMS fails. See Chapter 9.1.3 for a list of
result codes.
1
Compatible to M20.
If the M20 mode is active, TA returns OK, no matter whether
or not AT+CMGW was successfully executed.
Note
Siemens
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 193 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.19 AT^SNFA Set or query microphone attenuation
Test command
Response
AT^SNFA=?
^SNFA: (list of supported <atten>s)
Parameter
See read command
Read command
Response
AT^SNFA?
TA returns the current attenuation value on the microphone path for the current
audio device (selected by AT^SNFS, see section 8.25).
^SNFA: <atten> OK
<atten> integer type value
0 (0x0) – 65535 (0xFFFF)
attenuation = 20 log(<atten>/32767)
0
=> microphone is muted
32767 => no attenuation on the microphone path
values greater than 32767 are not used
Write command
AT^SNFA=
<atten>
TA controls the large-scale attenuation on the microphone path for the current
audio device (selected by AT^SNFS, see 8.25) with the following restrictions:
- it is not allowed for audio device 1
- as long as the microphone is muted, the write-command is temporarily disabled
- setting of value 0 is not allowed (use AT^SNFM=0 for this; see section 8.22).
- for values greater than 32767, 32767 will be used
Response
OK
If error is related to ME functionality
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
See read command
Reference
Command does not require a PIN. The command is provided for compatibility with
M20 and is an alternative to AT^SNFI (see section 0, second parameter). Both
commands use the same audio parameter inCalibrate. To make the changes persistent use AT^SNFW (see section 8.27).
Examples
^SYSSTART
at^snfa=?
^SNFA: (0-65535)
OK
at^snfa?
^SNFA: 32767
OK
at^snfs=4
OK
at^snfa=1
OK
at^snfa?
^SNFA: 1
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 194 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
OK
at^snfi?
^SNFI: 5,1
OK
at^snfi=5,45
OK
at^snfa?
^SNFA: 45
OK
8.20 AT^SNFD Set audio parameters to manufacturer default values
Test command
Response
AT^SNFD=?
OK
Execute command
Response
AT^SNFD
TA sets the active audio parameters to manufacturer defined default values.
OK
Reference
Note
Siemens
The restored values are: <inBbcGain>, <inCalibrate>, <outBbcGain>, <outCalibrate[0 to 4]>, <sideTone> of all audio modes
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 195 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.21 AT^SNFI Set microphone path parameters
Test command
Response
AT^SNFI=?
^SNFI: (list of supported <inBbcGain>s), (list of supported <inCalibrate>s) OK
Parameters
See write command
Read command
Response
AT^SNFI?
^SNFI: < inBbcGain >, <inCalibrate> OK
Parameters
See write command
Write command
Response
AT^SNFI=<inBbcGain>,
<inCalibrate>
TA sets microphone path amplifying.
OK
Parameters
<inBbcGain>
Setting for ADC gain Amplifier 0 - 7 (0=0dB, 7=42dB,
8 steps of 6 dB)
<inCalibrate>
Multiplication factor 0 – 32767 for input samples attenuation=20*log (inCalibrate/32767)
Reference
Note
Siemens
• Write command works only in audio modes 2 to 6!
• Read and write options of this command refer to the active audio
mode.
• The range of <inCalibrate> is up to 65535 but will be suppressed to
32767. Values above <inCalibrate> = 65535 will cause a failure
• Changed values have to be stored with ^SNFW.
• Attention! When you adjust audio parameters avoid exceeding the
maximum allowed level. Bear in mind that exposure to excessive levels of noise can cause physical damage to users!
• The default values are customer specific.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 196 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.22 AT^SNFM Mute microphone
Test command
Response
AT^SNFM=?
^SNFM: (list of supported <mute>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT^SNFM?
^SNFM: <mute> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT^SNFM=<mute>
TA switches on/off the microphone
OK
Parameter
<mute>
0 Mute microphone
1 Microphone on
Reference
Note
Siemens
This command can be used in all audio modes and during a voice call
only.
8.23 Audio programming model
The following figure illustrates how the signal path can be adjusted with the AT command parameters
described in the Chapters 0 to 8.27
2,65V
1k
inCalibrate
1k
-∞...0dB
A
10uF
1k
+0..42dB in
6dB-steps
1k
inBbcGain
D
speechcoder
sideTone
6,8R
6,8R
D
A
speechdecoder
+
(0dB; -6db,
-12dB; -18dB)
outCalibrate[n]
n = 0...4
outBbcGain
AT parameters
Figure 1: AT audio programming model
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 197 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.24 AT^SNFO Set audio output (= loudspeaker path) parameter
Test command
Response
AT^SNFO=?
^SNFO: (list of supported <outBbc Gain>), (list of supported <outCalibrate[0...4] >), (list of supported <outStep>), (list of supported <sideTone>s)
OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT^SNFO?
^SNFO: <outBbcGain>,
<sideTone>
OK
<outCalibrate[0]>,...<outCalibrate[4]>,
<outStep>,
Parameter
See write command
Write command
AT^SNFO=<outBbcGain>,<outCalibrate[0]>,...<outCali
brate[4]>,<outStep>,<sideTone>
Set TA's loudspeaker path parameters.
Response
<outBbcGain> <outCalibrate[0]>...<outCalibrate[4]> <(outStep)> <sideTone>
OK
Parameters
<outBbcGain>
Setting for DAC gain amplifier attenuation 0 – 3 (0=0 dB,
3=-18 dB, 4 steps of 6 dB)
<outCalibrate[0]> ... <outCalibrate[4]>
Multiplication factor 0 – 32767 for output samples
Attenuation = 20 * log (outCalibrate[n]/32767)
<outStep>
Setting of actual volume; 0 – 4, i.e. outCalibrate[n]
<sideTone>
Multiplication factor 0 – 32767 determining how much of
the original microphone signal is added to the earpiece
signal.
Side Tone Gain/dB = 20 * log (sideTone/32767)
Reference
Note
Siemens
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Write command works only in audio modes 2 to 6!
Read and write options of this command refer to the active audio mode.
The values <outStep> can be changed also by ^SNFV.
The range of <outCalibrate> is up to 65535 but will be suppressed to
32767. A value above <outCalibrate> = 65535 will cause a error
Changed values will not be stored automatically, but via the AT command
AT^SNFW except <outStep>. The parameter <outStep> will be saved after
AT^SMSO only.
The volume level as well as mute affects all audio modes.
In case of audio mode 1 the parameter <outStep> has no effect.
CAUTION! When you adjust audio parameters avoid exceeding the maximum allowed level. Bear in mind that exposure to excessive levels of noise
can cause physical damage to users!
Page 198 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.25 AT^SNFS Select audio hardware set
Test command
Response
AT^SNFS=?
^SNFS: (list of supported <audMode>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT^SNFS?
^SNFS: <audMode> OK
Parameter
Write command
AT^SNFS=
<audMode>
See write command
The write command serves to set the audio mode required for the connected
equipment. Please note that the selected mode is not saved to the non-volatile
store and needs to be restored manually, if the GSM engine was powered down.
Response
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+ CME ERROR: <error>
Parameters
Reference
<audMode> 1
Audio mode 1: Standard mode optimized for the default handset,
that can be connected to the analog interface 1 (see your
"Hardware Interface Description" for information on this handset.) To adjust the volume use the knob of the default handset.
This handset can be used in audio mode 4 with user defined parameters.
Note: The default parameters are determined for type approval
and are not adjustable with AT commands.
2
Audio mode 2: Customer specific mode for a basic handsfree
device (Siemens Car Kit Portable) connected to the analog interface 2. Audio parameters can be adjusted with AT commands
3
Audio mode 3: Customer specific mode for a mono-headset that
connects to the analog interface 2. Audio parameters can be
adjusted with AT commands.
4
Audio mode 4: Customer specific mode for a user handset that
connects to the analog interface 1. Audio parameters can be
adjusted with AT commands.
5
Audio mode 5: Customer specific mode intended for the analog
interface 1. Audio parameters can be adjusted with AT commands.
6
Audio mode 6: Customer specific mode intended for the analog
interface 2. Audio parameters can be adjusted with AT commands.
Note
Siemens
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 199 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.26 AT^SNFV Set loudspeaker volume
Test command
Response
AT^SNFV=?
^SNFV: (list of supported <outStep>s) OK
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT^SNFV?
^SNFV: <outStep>
OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT^SNFV=<out
Step>
TA sets the volume of the loudspeaker to the value <outCalibrate> addressed by
<outStep>.
OK
Parameter
<outStep>
Reference
Note
Siemens
•
•
•
•
•
Volume range 0 to 4
Read and write commands are related to the active audio mode.
The changes are allowed in audio modes 2 to 6.
<outStep> can be changed by AT^SNFO, too.
<outCalibrate> can be changed by AT^SNFO.
AT^SNFW does not save the changed <outStep> value. The setting will be
saved when you switch off the module with AT^SMSO.
8.27 AT^SNFW Write audio setting in non-volatile store
Test command
Response
AT^SNFW=?
OK
Execute command
Response
AT^SNFW
TA writes the active audio parameters in non-volatile store related to the active
mode.
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+ CME ERROR: <error>
<error> memory failure Flash write error
Reference
Note
Siemens
• Execute command works only in audio mode 2 to 6.
• TA writes the following audio parameter values in non-volatile store:
<inBbcGain>, <inCalibrate>, <outBbcGain>, <outCalibrate[0]> ... <outCalibrate[4]>, <side Tone>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 200 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.28 AT^SPBC Search the first entry in the sorted telephone book
Test command
Response
AT^SPBC=?
^SPBC: (list of sorted telephone books supported <mem>s)
See AT+CPBS/AT^SPBS
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Write command
Parameter
AT^SPBC=<char>
<char>
First letter of searched entry
<index>
Index in the sorted telephone book (access via AT^SPBG)
Response
^SPBC: <index>
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Reference
Note
Siemens
There is no difference between small and capital letters.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 201 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.29 AT^SPBG Read entry from active telephone book via sorted index
This command sorts the active phonebook records by name, in alphabetical order. Please note that
the alphabetical order is assigned an index of its own which is not identical with the location numbers used in the various phonebooks.
CAUTION: The AT^SBPG command is intended for reading only. For example, it helps you find entries starting with matching characters. However, do not use the listed index numbers to dial out or
modify entries.
Test command
Response
AT^SPBG=?
^SPBG: (list of used <index>s), <nlength>, <tlength>
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<index>
Total number of entries stored in the active phonebook; displayed as
a range of serial numbers (1 – n).
<nlength>
Max. length of phone number
<tlength>
Max. length of the text associated with the phone number
Execute command
Response
AT^SPBG=
<index1>
[, <index2>]
^SPBG: <index1>, <number>, <type>, <text>[<CR><CL>
^SPBG: .....
^SPBG: <index2>, <number>, <type>, <text> ]
OK/ERROR/+CME ERROR
Parameter
<index1>
Serial number assigned to the position in the alphabetical list where
reading of entries starts
<index2>
Serial number assigned to the position in the alphabetical list where
reading of entries ends
<number>
Phone number
<type>
Type of phone number
<text>
Text associated with phone number
Reference
Note
Siemens
The AT^SPBG feature is able to sort by the first 6 matching characters only. All
the following characters will be ignored.
Example
1. First, run the Test command to find out the range of phonebook entries stored
in the active phonebook:
AT^SPBG=?
TA returns the number of entries in the format: ^SPBG: (1-33),20,17 where 33
is the total number of entries.
2. Now, run the Execute command to display the phonebook entries by alphabetical order. It is recommended to enter the full range to obtain best results.
AT^SPBG=1,33
TA returns phonebook entries by alphabetical order:
^SPBG: 1,"+999999",145,"Arthur"
^SPBG: 2,"+777777",145,"Bill"
^SPBG: 3,"+888888",145,"Charlie" .........
The numbers at the beginning of each line are not the memory locations in the
phonebook, but only serial numbers assigned to the alphabetical list.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 202 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.30 AT^SPBS Steps the selected phonebook alphabetically
This command can be used to flick through the active phonebook records in alphabetical order by
name.
CAUTION: The AT^SBPS command is intended for reading only. For example, it helps you find entries starting with matching characters. However, do not use the listed index numbers to dial out or
modify entries.
Test command
Response
AT^SPBS=?
^SPBS: (list of supported <value>s)
OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Parameter
AT^SPBS=
<value>
<value> 1 to make a step downward in the alphabetically sorted phonebook
2 to make a step upward in the alphabetically sorted phonebook
Response
If <value>=1
TA steps down one entry.
^SPBS: <index2>,<number>,<type>,<text> <CR,LF>
^SPBS: <index3>,<number>,<type>,<text> <CR,LF>
^SPBS: <index4>,<number>,<type>,<text> <CR,LF>,<CR,LF>
OK
If <value>=2 (after <value>=1)
TA steps up one entry.
^SPBS: <index1>,<number>,<type>,<text> <CR,LF>
^SPBS: <index2>,<number>,<type>,<text> <CR,LF>
^SPBS: <index3>,<number>,<type>,<text> <CR,LF>,<CR,LF>
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
The response parameters are explained in the specification of the “AT^SPBG”
command.
Reference
Note
Siemens
This command can be used for the ME, SM and FD phonebook.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 203 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.31 AT^SPIC Display PIN counter
Test command
Response
AT^SPIC=?
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
Execute command
AT^SPIC
TA returns the number of attempts still available for entering a required password,
e.g. the PIN, PUK, PH-SIM PUK etc. To check whether or not you need to enter a
password use the “AT+CPIN?” command.
Response
^SPIC: <counter> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<counter> Number of attempts counted down after each failure.
Reference
Note
Siemens
• When entering the SIM PIN or PUK you have a maximum of three attempts to
enter each number.
• For passwords associated to the phone lock ("PS" lock set by client or factory)
or other factory set locks, such as "PF", "PN", "PU", "PP", "PC" the number of
attempts is subject to a timing algorithm explained in Chapter 4.35.1. If these
passwords are incorrectly entered the counter first returns 3, 2 and 1 remaining
attempt(s), but then gives the total number of attempts which amounts to 63
(see example below).
• See also Chapters 4.21, 4.35 4.36, 4.38, 8.13 for further information on locks
and passwords.
Example
Though a mobile is locked to a specific SIM card (phone lock), the client attempts
to operate it with another SIM card. The client correctly enters the SIM PIN of the
SIM card currently inserted, but then fails to give the "PS" lock password (PH-SIM
PUK):
at+cpin=9999
OK
at+cpin?
+CPIN: PH-SIM PIN
OK
ME is waiting for the phone lock password
at^spic
^SPIC: 3
OK
at+cpin=4711
+CME ERROR: PH-SIM PIN required
at+cpin=4712
+CME ERROR: incorrect password
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 204 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
at^spic
^SPIC: 1
OK
at+cpin=4713
+CME ERROR: incorrect password
at^spic
^SPIC: 63
OK
at+cpin=4714
+CME ERROR: incorrect password
at^spic
^SPIC: 63
8.32 AT^SPLM Read the PLMN list
Test command
Response
AT^SPLM=?
OK
Parameter
See execute command
Execute command
Response
AT^SPLM
TA returns the list of operator names from the ME. Each operator code <numericn> that has an alphanumeric equivalent <alphan> in the ME memory is returned.
^SPLM: numeric <numeric1>,long alphanumeric <alpha1><CR><LF>
^SPLM:.....OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<numericn>
<alphan>
string type; operator in numeric form; GSM location area identification number
string type; operator in long alphanumeric format; can contain up to
16 characters
Reference
Note
Siemens
See also GSM 07.07: +COPN, +COPS
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 205 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.33 AT^SPLR Read entry from the preferred operators list
Test command
Response
AT^SPLR=?
TA returns the whole index range supported by the SIM.
^SPLR: (list of supported <index>s) OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT^SPLR=
<index1>[,
<index2>]
TA returns used entries from the SIM list of preferred operators with <index> between <index1> and <index2>. If <index2> is not given, only entry with <index1> is
returned.
^SPLR: <index1>, <oper>
^SPLR: .....
^SPLR: <index2>, <oper> OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<index1>
<index2>
<oper>
location number to read from
location number to read to
string type; operator in numeric form; GSM location area identification
number
Reference
Note
Siemens
GSM 07.07: AT+CPOL
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 206 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.34 AT^SPLW Write an entry to the preferred operators list
Test command
Response
AT^SPLW=?
TA returns the whole index range supported by the SIM.
^SPLW: (list of supported <index>s) OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Parameter
AT^SPLW=
<index>
[,<oper>]
TA writes an entry to the SIM list of preferred operators at location number <index>. If <index> is given but <oper> is left out, the entry is deleted. If <oper> is
given but <index> is left out, <oper> is inserted in the next free location.
<index> location number
<oper>
string type; operator in numeric form; GSM location area identification
number
Note: <oper> is a 5 digit number, 3 digits country code and 2 digits for
the Network provider.
Response
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Reference
Note
Siemens
See also GSM 07.07: AT+CPOL
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 207 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.35 AT^SPWD Change password for a lock
Test command
Response
AT^SPWD=?
^SPWD: (list of supported (<fac>, <pwdlength>)s) OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Parameter
<fac>
“P2” PIN2
otherwise see write command without “FD”
<pwdlength>integer, max. length of password
Write command
Parameter
AT^SPWD =
<fac>, <oldpwd>,<newpwd>
<fac>
Phone security passwords
“SC” SIM card (PIN)
“P2” PIN 2
“PS” Phone locked to SIM (device code)
Factory set locks
“PF” lock Phone to the very first SIM card
“PN” Network Personalisation
“PU” Network subset Personalisation
“PP” Service Provider Personalisation
“PC” Corporate Personalisation
Supplementary Service: Call barring
“AO” BAOC ( Bar All Outgoing Calls)
“OI”
BOIC ( Bar Outgoing International Calls)
“OX” BOIC-exHC (Bar Outgoing International Calls except to Home
Country)
“AI”
BAIC ( Bar All Incoming Calls)
“IR”
BIC-Roam ( Bar Incoming Calls when Roaming outside the
home country)
“AB” All Barring services
“AG” All outGoing barring services
“AC” All inComing barring services
Note: All call barring types have usually the same ME <password> to
lock and unlock. The default <password> is supplied from the network
provider. TA sets a new password for the facility lock function.
<oldpwd>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Password specified for the facility from the user interface or with
command.
Can be ignored if no old password was allocated to the facility. Take
into account that a password may have already been set by factory,
or that the service is subject to a password issued by the provider.
Page 208 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
See notes above or contact provider.
if <fac> = “SC” then PIN
if <fac> = “AO”...”AC” (barring) then network password (if needed)
if <fac> = “P2” then PIN2
<newpwd> new password
Response
OK
If error is related to ME functionality:
+CME ERROR: <err>
Reference
Note
Siemens
See also specification of AT+ CPWD in GSM 07.07 and further details in Chapter
4.38.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 209 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.36 AT^SSDA Set Display Availability
Use the AT^SSDA command to specify whether your MC35 product is designed to provide a display.
If there is one available, AT^SSDA enables or disables the mobile station to present incoming
Class 0 short messages directly on the display. The command is not required for other short message Classes.
Test command
Response
AT^SSDA =?
^SSDA: (list of supported <da>s)
Parameter
See write command
Read command
Response
AT^ SSDA?
^SSDA: <da> OK
Parameter
See write command
Write command
Response
AT^SSDA=
<da>
OK
Parameter
<da>: display availability
0
1
the mobile station is not capable of displaying short messages
the mobile station is capable of displaying short messages
Reference
Note
Siemens
If a mobile station is able display short messages, class 0 messages shall be displayed immediately. If the mobile station has no display, class 0 messages shall
be treated as though there was no message class.
Refer to GSM 03.38.
The setting of <da> influences the behaviour of the <mt> parameter in the command AT+CNMI. This is the only effect of this command. If <da> and <mt> equal
1, Class 0 short messages are treated as if <mt> are 2.
Multiplex protocol:
If using <da>=1 and <mt>=1 on one instance, all other instances have to use
<mt>=0.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 210 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.37 AT^SSYNC Configure SYNC Pin
The ^SSYNC command serves to configure the SYNC pin in the ZIF connector of the GSM engine.
Please note that the pin may be assigned different functions, depending on the design of the host
application. MC35 Terminal supports only <mode>=1.
For detailed information on the SYNC pin of the MC35 module refer to [1]. Before changing the
mode of the SYNC pin, carefully read the technical specifications.
Test command
Response
AT^SSYNC=?
^SSYNC: (list of supported <mode>s) OK
Parameter:
See write command
Read command
Response
AT^SSYNC?
+SSYNC: <mode> OK
Parameter:
See write command
Write command
Response
AT^SSYNC=
<mode>
OK
Parameter
<mode>
0 MC35 module: Enables the SYNC pin to indicate growing power
consumption during a transmit burst. You can make use of the signal generated by the SYNC pin, if power consumption is your concern. To do so, ensure that your application is capable of processing the signal. Your platform design must be such that the incoming
signal causes other components to draw less current. In short, this
allows your application to accomodate current drain and thus, supply sufficient current to the GSM engine if required.
MC35 Terminal: not applicable (do not select mode 0).
1 Enables the SYNC pin to control a status LED. On the MC35 Terminal, this is the LED placed on the front panel. If you use the
MC35 module, the SYNC pin can control an LED installed in your
application.
The LED functions described Table 10 are applicable both to the
module and the terminal.
Note: Mode 1 is the default mode for the MC35 Terminal.
Note
The SYNC pin mode is stored to the non-volatile Flash memory, and thus retained
after Power Down.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 211 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Table 10: Operating modes of the ME indicated by status LED (if <mode> = 1):
LED mode
Function
Off
MC35 module: ME is off or running in SLEEP, Alarm or
Charge-only mode.
MC35 Terminal: ME is off or in SLEEP mode.
600 ms On / 600ms Off
No SIM card inserted or no PIN entered, or network
search in progress, or ongoing user authentication, or
network login in progress.
75 ms On / 3 s Off
Logged to network (monitoring control channels and user
interactions). No call in progress.
75 ms on / 75 ms Off / 75 ms On / 3 s Off One or more GPRS contexts activated.
Flashing
Indicates GPRS data transfer: When a GPRS transfer is in
progress, the LED goes on within 1 second after data
packets were exchanged. Flash duration is approximately
0.5 s.
On
Depending on type of call:
Voice call: Connected to remote party.
Data call: Connected to remote party or exchange of parameters while setting up or disconnecting a call.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 212 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
8.38 AT^STCD Display Total Call Duration
Test command
Response
AT^STCD=?
OK
Execute command
Response
AT^STCD
TA returns total call duration (accumulated duration of all calls)
^STCD: <time> OK
Parameter
<time>
string type value; format is "hh:mm:ss", where characters indicate
hours, minutes, seconds; E.g. 22:10:00 “22:10:00"
max value is 9999:59:59
Reference
Note
Siemens
The Total Call Duration will not be reset by power off or other means.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 213 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
9 APPENDIX
9.1
Summary of ERRORS and Messages
The final result codes +CME ERROR: <err> and +CMS ERROR: <err> indicate errors related to mobile equipment or network. The effect is similar to an ERROR result code.
A final result error code terminates the execution of the command and prevents the execution of all
remaining commands that may follow on the same command line. If so, neither ERROR nor OK result
code are returned. A 30 seconds timeout causes ERROR to be returned when the input of a command
is not complete.
The format of <err> can be either numeric or verbose. This is set with the AT+CMEE command (see
Chapter 4.26).
9.1.1 Summary of CME ERRORS related to GSM 07.07
Code of <err>
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
30
31
32
40
41
Meaning
phone failure
no connection to phone
phone-adapter link reserved
Operation not allowed
Operation not supported
PH-SIM PIN required
PH-FSIM PIN required
PH-FSIM PUK required
SIM not inserted
SIM PIN required
SIM PUK required
SIM failure
SIM busy
SIM wrong
Incorrect password
SIM PIN2 required
SIM PUK2 required
Memory full
invalid index
not found
Memory failure
text string too long
invalid characters in text string
dial string too long
invalid characters in dial string
no network service
Network timeout
Network not allowed emergency calls only
Network personalization PIN required
Network personalization PUK required
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 214 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Code of <err>
42
43
44
45
46
47
100
Meaning
Network subset personalization PIN required
Network subset personalization PUK required
service provider personalization PIN required
service provider personalization PUK required
Corporate personalization PIN required
Corporate personalization PUK required
PH-SIM PUK required
(PH-SIM PUK may also be referred to as Master Phone Code. For further details
see Chapters 4.21.2 and 4.35.1)
Unknown
256
257
258
259
260
261
262
Operation temporarily not allowed
call barred
phone is busy
user abort
invalid dial string
ss not executed
SIM blocked
48
Note: Values below 256 are reserved.
9.1.2 Summary of GPRS-related CME ERRORS
Code of <err>
103
106
107
111
112
113
132
133
134
148
149
150
Meaning
Illegal MS
Illegal ME
GPRS services not allowed
PLMN not allowed
Location area not allowed
Roaming not allowed in this location area
service option not supported
requested service option not subscribed
service option temporarily out of order
unspecified GPRS error
PDP authentication failure
invalid mobile class
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 215 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
9.1.3 Summary of CMS ERRORS related to GSM 07.05
Code of <err>
1
8
10
21
27
28
29
30
38
41
42
47
50
69
81
95
96
97
98
99
111
127
128
129
130
143
144
145
159
160
161
175
176
192
193
194
195
196
197
198
199
208
209
210
211
212
Meaning
Unassigned (unallocated) number
Operator determined barring
Call barred
Short message transfer rejected
Destination out of service
Unidentified subscriber
Facility rejected
Unknown subscriber
Network out of order
Temporary failure
Congestion
Resources unavailable, unspecified
Requested facility not subscribed
Requested facility not implemented
Invalid short message transfer reference value
Invalid message, unspecified
Invalid mandatory information
Message type non-existent or not implemented
Message not compatible with short message protocol state
Information element non-existent or not implemented
Protocol error, unspecified
Interworking, unspecified
Telematic interworking not supported
Short message Type 0 not supported
Cannot replace short message
Unspecified TP-PID error
Data coding scheme (alphabet) not supported
Message class not supported
Unspecified TP-DCS error
Command cannot be actioned
Command unsupported
Unspecified TP-Command error
TPDU not supported
SC busy
No SC subscription
SC system failure
Invalid SME address
Destination SME barred
SM Rejected-Duplicate SM
TP-VPF not supported
TP-VP not supported
D0 SIM SMS storage full
No SMS storage capability in SIM
Error in MS
Memory Capacity Exceeded
SIM Application Toolkit Busy
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 216 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Code of <err>
213
255
300
301
302
303
304
305
310
311
312
313
314
315
316
317
318
320
321
322
330
331
332
340
500
512
513
514
515
516
517
518
519
520
521
Meaning
SIM data download error
Unspecified error cause
ME failure
SMS service of ME reserved
Operation not allowed
Operation not supported
Invalid PDU mode parameter
Invalid text mode parameter
SIM not inserted
SIM PIN required
PH-SIM PIN required
SIM failure
SIM busy
SIM wrong
SIM PUK required
SIM PIN2 required
SIM PUK2 required
Memory failure
Invalid memory index
Memory full
SMSC address unknown
no network service
Network timeout
NO +CNMA ACK EXPECTED
Unknown error
User abort
unable to store
invalid status
invalid character in address string
invalid length
invalid character in pdu
invalid parameter
invalid length or character
invalid character in text
timer expired
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 217 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
9.1.4 Summary of Unsolicited Result Codes (URC)
A URC is a report message sent from the ME to the TE. An unsolicited result code can either be delivered automatically when an event occurs or as a result of a query the ME received before. However, a
URC is not issued as a direct response to an executed AT command.
When sending a URC the ME activates its Ring Line (Logic "1"), i.e. the line goes active low for 1 second.
Typical URCs may be information about incoming calls, received SMS, changing temperature, status
of the battery etc. A summary of all URCs is listed below.
For each of these messages, you can configure the ME whether or not to send an unsolicited result
code. Remember that the presentation mode of URCs will be reset to the default values
• when you power down the GSM engine, e.g. with AT^SMSO or when disconnecting power supply,
• when you reset the engine with AT+CFUN=1,1
• when you restore the factory settings with AT&F.
To take advantage of the messages, you need to activate the desired URC every time you reboot the
GSM engine or have the parameters included in the user profile saved with AT&W. If you do so, take
into account that the two URCs ^SBC and ^SCTM cannot be saved with the user profile and, thus,
need to be reactivated when needed after reboot.
The URCs SYSSTART, SYSSTART CHARGE-ONLY MODE and SYSSTART ALARM MODE are not
user definable.
Message
Meaning
+CCCM: <ccm>
+CREG: <stat>[,<lac>,<ci>]
Current call meter value
Registration to ME network changed
+CRING: <type>
+CLIP: <number>, <type>
+CMTI:<mem>,<index>
Indication of an incoming call
Telephone number of caller
Indication of a new short message (text
and PDU mode)
Short message is output directly to the
TE (in PDU mode)
Short message is output directly to the
TE (in text mode)
+CMT:,<length><CR><LF><pdu>
+CMT:<oa>,,<scts>[,<tooa>,<fo>,
<pid>,<dcs>,<sca>,<tosca>,
<length>]<CR><LF><data>
+CBM:<sn>,<mid>,<dcs>,<page>,
<pages><CR> <LF><data>
+CBM: <length><CR><LF><pdu>
+CDS: <length><CR><LF><pdu>
+CDS: <fo>,<mr>,[<ra>],[<tora>],
<scts>,<dt>, <st>
+CDSI: <mem>,<index>
+CSSI: <code1>
+CSSU: <code2>
^SMGO: <mode>
^SCKS: <m>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Cell broadcast message is output directly
to the TE (in text mode)
Cell broadcast message is output directly
to the TE (in PDU mode)
SMS status report routed directly to TE
(in PDU mode)
SMS status report routed directly to TE
(in text mode)
How to activate
URC
AT^CACM=1
AT+CREG=1 or
AT+CREG=2
AT+CRC=1
AT+CLIP=1
AT+CNMI=1,1
Example:
AT+CNMI=1,2
Example:
AT+CNMI=1,2
Example:
AT+CNMI=1,0,2
Examples:
AT+CNMI=1,0,2
Example:
AT+CNMI=1,0,0,1
SMS status report routed ME/TA. Can be Example:
queried from the memory with location
AT+CNMI=1,0,0,2
index number (text and PDU mode)
Supplementary service intermediAT+CSSN=1,1
ate/unsolicited result code
SMS overflow indicator
Indicates whether card has been removed or inserted
Page 218 of 238
AT^SMGO=1
AT^SCKS=1
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Message
Meaning
^SCTM_A: <m>
^SCTM_B: <m>
Battery (A) or board (B) is close to or beyond critical temperature limit. URC is issued repeatedly. If <m>=2 or <m>-2, ME
switches off.
Undervoltage of battery detected. ME will AT^SBC=<current>
be switched off within a minute.
^SBC: Undervoltage
How to activate
URC
AT^SCTM=1
^SYSSTART
Indicates that ME has successfully been
started.
Note that this URC will not appear if
autobauding is enabled.
^SYSSTART CHARGE-ONLY
MODE
Only applicable to battery operated MEs: Not defined by user
URC indicates that ME has entered the
Charge-only mode.
Charge-only mode allows charging while
ME is detached from network. Limited
number of AT commands is accessible.
Mode can be launched by connecting the
battery charger to the POWER pins of
the ZIF connector, before or after powering down ME with AT^SMSO.
Note that this URC will not appear if
autobauding is enabled.
^SYSSTART ALARM MODE
Indicates that ME has entered Alarm
mode.
RTC alert set with the AT+CALA command. Executed when ME has been
powered down. Causes ME to wake up
from Power Down mode. Preventing ME
from unintentionally registering to the
network, Alarm mode allows limited operation. Limited number of AT commands is accessible. Do not confuse
with wake-up or reminder call.
Note that this URC will not appear if
autobauding is enabled.
Wake-up or reminder call set with
AT+CALA command. Executed while ME
is in normal operation. Do not confuse
with Alarm mode.
Enabled when you
configure Alarm
mode
Reports changes from indicators listed in
the AT+CIND command specification.
AT+CMER=2,0,0,2
AT+CMER=3,0,0,2
or, if individual text available:
^SYSSTART ALARM MODE
+CALA: <text>
+CALA: <text>
+CIEV: <text>
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 219 of 238
Not defined by user
Enabled when you
set wake-up call
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
9.1.5 Result codes
Indication
OK
CONNECT
RING
NO CARRIER
ERROR
NO DIALTONE
BUSY
CONNECT 2400
CONNECT 4800
CONNECT 9600
CONNECT 2400/RLP
CONNECT 4800/RLP
CONNECT 9600/RLP
ALERTING
DIALING
Numeric
0
1
2
3
4
6
7
10
30
32
47
48
49
Meaning
Command executed, no errors, Wake up after reset
Link established
Ring detected
Link not established or disconnected
Invalid command or command line too long
No dial tone, dialling impossible, wrong mode
Remote station busy
Link with 2400 bps
Link with 4800 bps
Link with 9600 bps
Link with 2400 bps and Radio Link Protocol
Link with 4800 bps and Radio Link Protocol
Link with 9600 bps and Radio Link Protocol
Alerting at called phone
Mobile phone is dialing
9.1.6 Cause Location ID for the extended error report (AT+CEER)
ID
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
21
22
32
33
34
35
48
49
Description
No error (default)
SIEMENS L2 cause
GSM cause for L3 Radio Resource Sublayer (GSM 04.08 annex F)
SIEMENS cause for L3 Radio Ressource Sublayer
GSM cause for L3 Mobility Management (GSM 04.08 annex G)
SIEMENS cause for L3 Mobility Management
GSM cause for L3 Mobility Management via MMR-SAP (GSM 04.08 annex G)
SIEMENS cause for L3 Mobility Management via MMR-SAP
GSM cause for L3 Call Control (GSM 04.08 10.5.4.11 and annex H)
SIEMENS cause for L3 Call Control
SIEMENS cause for L3 Advice of Charge Entity
GSM cause for L3 SMS CP Entity
SIEMENS cause for L3 SMS CP Entity
GSM cause for L3 SMS RL Entity
SIEMENS cause for L3 SMS RL Entity
GSM cause for L3 SMS TL Entity
SIEMENS cause for L3 SMS TL Entity
SIEMENS cause for DSM Entity
GSM cause for L3 Call-related Supplementary Services
SIEMENS cause for L3 Call-related Supplementary Services
SIEMENS cause for Supplementary Services Entity
SIEMENS cause for Supplementary Services Manager
Network cause for Supplementary Services (GSM 04.08 10.5.4.11 and annex H)
Supplementary Services network error (GSM 04.80 3.6.6)
GSM cause for GPRS Mobility Management (GSM 04.08 annex G.6)
SIEMENS cause for GPRS Mobility Management
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 220 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
50
51
128
129
130
131
241
242
243
GSM cause for Session Management (GSM 04.08 annex I)
SIEMENS cause for Session Management
Supplementary Services general problem (GSM 04.80 3.6.7)
Supplementary Services invoke problem (GSM 04.80 3.6.7)
Supplementary Services result problem (GSM 04.80 3.6.7)
Supplementary Services error problem (GSM 04.80 3.6.7)
SIEMENS cause for GPRS API
SIEMENS cause for Link Management
SIEMENS cause for Embedded Netcore (Internet Protocol Stack)
9.1.7 GSM release cause for L3 Radio Resource (RR) (AT+CEER)
Number
0
1
2
3
4
5
8
9
10
65
95
96
97
98
100
101
111
Description
Normal event
Abnormal release, unspecified
Abnormal release, channel unacceptable
Abnormal release, timer expired
Abnormal release, no activity on the radio path
Pre-emptive release
Handover impossible, timing advance out of range
Channel mode unacceptable
Frequency not implemented
Call already cleared
Semantically incorrect message
Invalid mandantory information
Message type non-existent or not implemented
Message type not compatible with protocol state
Conditional information element error
No cell allocation available
Protocol error unspecified
9.1.8 SIEMENS release cause for L3 Radio Resource (RR) (AT+CEER)
Number
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Description
Racchs not answered
Racchs rejected
Access class of the SIM is barred by the network provider
SABM failure
Radio link counter expiry or PerformAbnormalRelease
Confirm ABORT of the MM
Respond to DEACT_REQ
Loss of coverage
Reestablishment not possible
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 221 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
9.1.9 GSM release cause for L3 Mobility Management (MM) (AT+CEER)
Number
Description
Causes related to MS identification
2
IMSI unknown in HLR
3
Illegal MS
4
IMSI unknown in VLR
5
IMEI not accepted
6
Illegal ME
Cause related to subscription options
11
PLMN not allowed
12
Location Area not allowed
13
Roaming not allowed in this location area
Causes related to PLMN specific network failures and congestion
17
Network failure
22
Congestion
Causes related to nature of request
32
Service option not supported
33
Requested service option not subscribed
34
Service option temporarily out of order
38
Call cannot be identified
Causes related to invalid messages
95
Semantically incorrect message
96
Invalid mandantory information
97
Message type non-existent or not implemented
98
Message not compatible with protocol state
99
Information element non-existent or not implemented
100
Conditional information element error
101
Messages not compatible with protocol state
111
Protocol error, unspecified
Causes related GPRS
7
GPRS services not allowed
8
GPRS services not allowed in combination with non-GPRS services
9
MS identity cannot be identified by the network
10
Implicitly detached
14
GPRS services not allowed in current PLMN
16
MSC temporarily unreachable
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 222 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
9.1.10 SIEMENS release cause for L3 Mobility Management (MM) (AT+CEER)
Number
1
8
9
11
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
Description
No SIM available
No MM connection
Authentification failure
MM performs detach
The registration failed and will be re-attempted in a short term
The CM connection establishment failed
The registration failed and will be re-attempt in a long term
The RR connection is released
The MS tries to register
The SPLMN is not available
An MTC is in progress
A PLMN scan is in progress
The MM is detached, the MS is in MS class C GPRS only
9.1.11 GSM release cause for L3 Call Control (CC) (AT+CEER)
Number
Description
0
No error
Normal class
1
Unassigned (unallocated) number
3
No route to destination
6
Channel unacceptable
8
Operator determined barring
16
Normal call clearing
17
User busy
18
No user responding
19
User alerting, no answer
21
Call rejected
22
Number changed
25
Pre-emption
26
Non-selected user clearing
27
Destination out of order
28
Invalid number format (incomplete number)
29
Facility rejected
30
Response to STATUS ENQUIRY
31
Normal, unspecified
Resource unavailable class
34
No circuit/channel available
38
Network out of order
41
Temporary failure
42
Switching equipment congestion
43
Access information discarded
44
Requested circuit/channel not available
47
Resource unavailable, unspecified
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 223 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Number
Description
Service or option not available class
49
Quality of service unavailable
50
Requested facility not subscribed
55
Incoming calls barred within the CUG
57
Bearer capability not authorized
58
Bearer capability presently not available
63
Service or option not available, unspecified
Service or option not implemented
65
Bearer service not implemented
68
ACM equal or greater than ACMmax
69
Requested facility not implemented
70
Only restricted digital information bearer capability is available
79
service or option not implemented, unspecified
Invalid message (e.g. parameter out of range) class
81
Invalid transaction identifier value
87
User not member of CUG
88
Incompatible destination
91
Invalid transit network selection
95
Semantically incorrect message
Protocol error (e.g. unknown message) class
96
Invalid mandantory information
97
Message type non-existant or not implemented
98
Message type not comaptible with protocol state
99
Information element non-existent or not implemented
100
Conditional information element error
101
Message not compatible with protocol
102
Recovery on timer expiry
111
Protocol error, unspecified
Interworking class
127
Interworking, unspecified
9.1.12 SIEMENS release cause for L3 Call Control (CC) (AT+CEER)
Number
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
10
Notifications
300
Description
Call dropped
Service not available
Hold procedure not available
Temporary no service, previous procedure not yet finished
No speech service available
Call reestablishment procedure active
Mobile received a release (complete) message during a modify procedure (modify reject)
Call clearing, because loss of radio connection, if no reestablishment is allowed (call
not active)
Number not included in FDN list
Called party barred incoming call
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 224 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
9.1.13 SIEMENS release cause for L3 Advice of Charge (AOC) (AT+CEER)
Number
1
2
3
4
5
Description
SIM data not available
SIM does not support AOC
SIM data access error
ACM limit almost reached ACM range overflow
ACM range overflow
9.1.14 GSM release cause for Supplementary Service call (AT+CEER)
Number
Description
0
No error (default)
1
UnknownSubscriber
9
IllegalSubscriber
10
BearerServiceNotProvisioned
11
TeleserviceNotProvisioned
12
IllegalEquipment
13
CallBarred
15
CUGReject
16
IllegalSSOperation
17
SSErrorStatus
18
SSNotAvailable
19
SSSubscriptionViolation
20
SSIncompatibility
21
FacilityNotSupported
27
AbsentSubscriber
29
ShortTermDenial
30
LongTermDenial
34
SystemFailure
35
DataMissing
36
UnexpectedDataValue
37
PWRegistrationFailure
38
NegativePWCheck
43
NumberOfPWAttemptsViolation
71
UnknownAlphabet
72
USSDBusy
126
MaxNumsOfMPTYCallsExceeded
127
ResourcesNotAvailable
General Problem Codes
300
Unrecognized Component
301
Mistyped Component
302
Badly Structured Component
Invoke Problem Codes
303
Duplicate Invoke ID
304
Unrecognized Operation
305
Mistyped Parameter
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 225 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Number
Description
306
Resource Limitation
307
Initiating Release
308
Unrecognized Linked ID
309
Linked Response Unexpected
310
Unexpected Linked Operation
Return Result Problem Codes
311
Unrecognize Invoke ID
312
Return Result Unexpected
313
Mistyped Parameter
Return Error Problem Codes
314
Unrecognized Invoke ID
315
Return Error Unexpected
316
Unrecognized Error
317
Unexpected Error
318
Mistyped Parameter
9.1.15 Siemens release cause for Call related Supplementary Services (CRSS)
(AT+CEER)
Number
0
1
2
3
4
5
Description
ECT procedure failed (timer expired)
Call has been cleared without receiving an answer to ECT request
Initial conditions not fulfilled (one active, one held call)
Received “return error”
Call has been cleared without receiving an answer to CCBS request
Initial conditions for CCBS not fulfilled (Idle CRSS)
9.1.16 GSM release cause for Session Management (SM) (AT+CEER)
Number
Description
Causes related to nature of request
25
LLC or SNDCP failure
26
Insufficient ressources
27
Unknown or missing access point name
28
Unknown PDP address or PDP type
29
User authentification failed
30
Activation rejected by GGSN
31
Activation rejected, unspecified
32
Service option not supported
33
Requested service option not subscribed
34
Service option temporarily out of order
35
NSAPI already used
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 226 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Number
Description
36
Regular PDP context deactivation
37
QoS not accepted
38
Network failure
39
Reactivation requested
40
Feature not supported
Causes related to invalid messages
81
Invalid transaction identifier value
95
Semantically incorrect message
96
Invalid mandantory information
97
Message type non-existant or not implemented
98
Message type not comaptible with protocol state
99
Information element non-existent or not implemented
100
Conditional information element error
101
Message not compatible with protocol
111
Protocol error, unspecified
9.1.17 SIEMENS release cause for Session Management (SM) (AT+CEER)
Number
3
4
5
6
7
Description
The MS has not got any answer to the ACTIVATE PDP CONTEXT request message
sent five times to the network
A MT PDP context which is active or in the activation process is deactivated because
another MT PDP context with the same TI is requested by the network to be activated
A MT PDP context which is active or in the activation process is deactivated because
another MT PDP context with the same TI is requested by the network to be activated.
The activation request is rejected by the SM sending the cause 'insufficient resources'
to the network because the SM was not able to perform the necessary comparisons
for a static PDP address collision detection.
A MT PDP context which is active or in the activation process is deactivated because
another MT PDP context with the same TI is requested by the network to be activated.
As a static PDP address collision with an MO activating PDP context has been detected by the SM the SM discards the activation request
A MT PDP context request has been indicated but could not be processed in time.
The activation request is rejected by the SM sending the cause 'insufficient resources'
to the network.
9.1.18 SIEMENS release cause for GPRS API (AT+CEER)
Number
0
1
2
3
4
255
Description
Regular deactivation of the call
Action temporarily not allowed
Wrong connection type
Specified data service profile invalid
PDP type or address is unknown
Undefined
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 227 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
9.1.19 SIEMENS release cause for Embedded Netcore (AT+CEER)
Number
0
1
255
Description
Regular call deactivation
LCP stopped
Undefined
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 228 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
9.2
Summary of PIN requiring AT Commands
The following table lists all the AT commands that are available after the PIN was entered.
AT command
Required PIN
Standard V25.ter AT commands
ATA
PIN 1
ATD
PIN 1
ATH
PIN 1
AT+ILRR
PIN 1
AT+VTS
PIN 1
AT commands originating from GSM 07.07
AT+CACM
PIN 1, PIN 2
AT+CAMM
PIN 1, PIN 2
AT+CAOC
PIN 1
AT+CCFC
PIN 1
AT+CCUG
PIN 1
AT+CCWA
PIN 1
AT+CEER
PIN 1
AT+CGACT
PIN 1
AT+CGATT
PIN 1
AT+CGDATA
PIN 1
AT+CGDCONT
PIN 1
AT+CGQMIN
PIN 1
AT+CGQREQ
PIN 1
AT+CHLD
PIN 1
AT+CHUP
PIN 1
AT+CIMI
PIN 1
AT+CLCC
PIN 1
AT+CLCK
PIN 1
AT+CLIP read
PIN 1
AT+CLIR
PIN 1
AT+CMER
PIN 1
AT+CMGC
PIN 1
AT+CMGD
PIN 1
AT+CMGL
PIN 1
AT+CMGR
PIN 1
AT+CMGS
PIN 1
AT+CMGW
PIN 1
AT+CMSS
PIN 1
AT+CNMA
PIN 1
AT+CNMI
PIN 1
AT+COPN
PIN 1
AT+CPBR
PIN 1
AT+CPBS
PIN 1
AT+CPBW
PIN 1
AT+CPMS
PIN 1
AT+CPUC
PIN 1, PIN 2
AT+CPWD
PIN 1, PIN 2
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 229 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
AT command
AT+CR
AT+CRSM
AT+CSCA
AT+CSCB
AT+CSDH
AT+CSMP
AT+CSMS
AT+CUSD
Siemens defined AT commands
AT^MONP
AT^MONI
AT^SACM
AT^SCNI
AT^SDLD
AT^SLCD
AT^SLCK
AT^SMGL
AT^SMGO
AT^SMGR
AT^SPBC
AT^SPBG
AT^SPBS
AT^SPLM
AT^SPLR
AT^SPLW
AT^SPWD
AT^SSDA
AT^STCD
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Required PIN
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1, PIN 2
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1
PIN 1, PIN 2
PIN 1
PIN 1
Page 230 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
9.3
AT commands available before entering the SIM PIN
The following table summarizes the AT commands you can use before the SIM PIN has been entered.
Explanation:
l
AT command usable without PIN
---
not usable without PIN
n.a.
AT command not available at all
AT command
Test
Standard V.25ter AT commands
ATD
n.a.
ATE
n.a.
ATI
n.a.
ATO
n.a.
ATQ
n.a.
ATS3
n.a.
ATS4
n.a.
ATS5
n.a.
AT\Q
n.a.
Read
Write /
Execute
n.a
n.a
n.a
n.a
n.a
l
l
l
n.a.
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
ATSn
n.a.
l
ATS18
n.a
ATV
n.a.
n.a
ATX
n.a.
n.a
ATZ
n.a.
n.a
AT&C
n.a.
n.a
AT&D
n.a.
n.a
AT&F
n.a.
n.a
AT&V
n.a.
n.a
l
l
AT+IPR
AT commands originating from GSM 07.07
l
l
AT+CALA
l
l
AT+CBST
l
l
AT+CCLK
l
l
AT+CFUN
l
AT+CGMI
n.a.
l
AT+CGMM
n.a.
l
AT+CGMR
n.a.
l
AT+CGSN
n.a.
l
l
AT+CIND
l
AT+CLIP
--l
l
AT+CLVL
For emergency calls only
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
AT+CMEE
AT+CMGF
AT+CMUT
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
AT+CMUX
l
l
Error
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Note
Page 231 of 238
Write command in audio mode 2-6
only
Write command depending on audio
mode
Only mode 0
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
AT command
Test
Read
AT+COPS
Phone busy
Unknown
l
AT+CPAS
n.a.
l
l
AT+CPIN
l
l
AT+CPIN2
l
l
AT+CR
l
l
AT+CRC
l
l
AT+CREG
l
l
AT+CRLP
l
l
AT+CSCS
l
l
AT+CSNS
l
AT+CSQ
--l
l
AT+CSSN
l
AT+GCAP
n.a.
l
AT+GMI
n.a.
l
AT+GMM
n.a.
l
AT+GMR
n.a.
l
AT+GSN
n.a.
l
l
AT+VTD
l
l
AT+WS46
Siemens defined AT commands
l
AT+CXXCID
n.a.
l
l
AT^SBC
l
AT^SCID
n.a.
l
l
AT^SBC
l
l
AT^SCKS
l
l
AT^SCTM
l
l
AT^SGAUTH
l
AT^SHOM
l
l
AT^SMSO
l
l
AT^SM20
l
l
AT^SNFA
l
AT^SNFD
n.a.
l
l
AT^SNFI
l
l
AT^SNFM
l
l
AT^SNFO
l
l
AT^SNFS
l
l
AT^SNFV
l
AT^SNFW
n.a.
l
AT^SPIC
n.a.
l
l
AT^SSYNC
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Write /
Execute
--l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Page 232 of 238
Note
Not useful without PIN
Only 0
12 (GSM digital cellular)
Write commd. in audio mode 2-6 only
Write commd. in audio mode 2-6 only
Write commd. in audio mode 2-6 only
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
9.4
Standard GSM service codes
The following GSM command strings can be sent with the ATD command. Reference: GSM 2.30
*# code
Functionality
Possible response(s)
Phone security
*#06#
Query IMEI
<IMEI> OK
**04*oldPIN*newPIN*newPIN#
Change PIN1
+CME ERROR: <err> /
**042*oldPIN2*newPIN2*newPIN2#
Change PIN2
OK
**05*unblKey*newPIN*newPIN#
Unlock PIN 1. (Unblock SIM card after
3 failed attempts to enter PIN1)
See also Chapters 4.21, 4.35, 4.35.1,
Unlock PIN2 (after 3 failed attempts to 4.36.
enter PIN2)
**052*unblKey*newPIN*newPIN#
*[*]03*[ZZ]*oldPw*newPw*newPw#
Registration of net password (change
call barring password)
Phone number presentation
*#30#
Check status of CLIP (Calling Line +CLIP : <n>,<m> OK (Chapter 4.22, p. 85)
Identification Presentation)
*#31#
Check status of CLIR (Calling Line +CLIR : <n>,<m> OK (Chapter 4.23, p.86)
Identification Restriction)
*31#<Phonenumber>[;]
Suppress CLIR
(Chapter 4.23, p.86)
#31#<Phonenumber>[;]
Activate CLIR
(Chapter 4.23, p.86)
*#76#
Check status of COLP (Connected Line
Identification Presentation)
+COLP: 0,<m> OK (where <m> = active or
not active)
*#77#
Check status of COLR (Connected Line
Identification Restriction)
+COLR: 0,<m> OK (where <m> = active or
not active)
(choice of *,#,*#,**,##)21*DN*BS#
Act/deact/int/reg/eras CFU
(choice of *,#,*#,**,##)67*DN*BS#
Act/deact/int/reg/eras CF busy
^SCCFC : <reason>, <status>, <class>
[,...] like +CCFC (Chapter 4.6, p. 62)
(choice of *,#,*#,**,##)61*DN*BS*T#
Act/deact/int/reg/eras CF no reply
(choice of *,#,*#,**,##)62*DN*BS#
Act/deact/int/reg/eras CF no reach
(choice of *,#,*#,**,##)002*DN*BS*T#
Act/deact/int/reg/eras CF all
(choice of *,#,*#,**,##)004*DN*BS*T#
Act/deact/int/reg/eras CF all cond.
Call forwarding (see also Chapter 9.4.1)
Call waiting (see also Chapter 9.4.1)
Activation/deactivation/int WAIT
+CCWA: <status>, <class> *)
(choice of *,#,*#)33*Pw*BS#
Act/deact/int BAOC
(choice of *,#,*#)331*Pw*BS#
Act/deact/int BAOIC
^SCLCK: <fac>, <status>, <class> [, ...]
like +CLCK *) (see Chapter 4.21, p. 79)
(choice of *,#,*#)332*Pw*BS#
Act/deact/int BAOIC exc.home
(choice of *,#,*#)35*Pw*BS#
Act/deact/int. BAIC
(choice of *,#,*#)351*Pw*BS#
Act/deact/int BAIC roaming
#330*Pw*BS#
#333*Pw*BS#
#353*Pw*BS#
Deact. All Barring Services
Deact. All Outg.Barring Services
Deactivation. All Inc.Barring Services
Call Hold / Multiparty
C[C] in call
Call hold and multiparty
(choice of *,#,*#)43*BS#
Call barring (see also Chapter 9.4.1)
+CME ERROR: <err> /
OK
USSD messages
[C]...[C]#
(varies with the serving network)
C[C] (excluded 1[C])
(varies with the serving network)
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Send USSD message
+CME ERROR: <err> /
OK
Send USSD message
(see Chapter 4.48, p. 122)
+CME ERROR: <err> /
OK
Page 233 of 238
(see Chapter 4.16, p. 74)
(see Chapter 4.48, p. 122)
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
Abbreviations of codes and responses
Codes / parameters to be sent with ATD
ZZ = type of supplementary services:
Barring services
330
All services
Not specified
DN = dialling number:
String of digits 0-9
BS = basic service
Voice
11
equivalent to parameter <class>
FAX
13
SMS
16
SMS +FAX
12
Voice + FAX
19
Voice + SMS + FAX
10
Data circuit asynchron
25
Data circuit synchron
24
PAD
27
Packet
26
Data circuit asynchron + PAD
21
Data circuit synchron + packet
22
Data circuit asynchron + syncron. + PAD
20
All Services
--T = time in seconds
PW = Password
C = character of TE character set (e.g. asterix, hash or digit in case of USSD, or digits in case of held calls or multiparty calls)
Possible responses
<m>
Mode: 0 = not active, 1 = active
<n>
Unsolicited result code: 0 = presentation disabled, 1 = presentation enabled
<status>
Status: 0 = not active, 1 = active
<class>
Represents BS = basic service
See Chapters 4.6 (AT+CCFC), 4.21 (AT+CLCK) and 9.4.1.
<fac>
Facility lock. See Chapter 4.21 (AT+CLCK)
<reason>
Call forwarding reason
Function of *# codes for Supplementary Services
*# code
*
**
*#
#
##
Abbreviation used in
Chapter 9.4
act
Activate (except for CLIR, see list above)
reg
Register and activate
int
Check status (interrogate)
deact
Deactivate (except for CLIR, see list above)
eras
Unregister and deactivate
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Function
Page 234 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
9.4.1 Additional notes on ^SCCFC, ^SCCWA, ^SCLCK
The output of ^SCCFC, ^SCCWA, ^SCLCK depends on the teleservices coded in <class>. If no teleservice or bearer service is active for a given interrogation “7” is generated as default value for the
<class> parameter, with only line being displayed (see example 1 below). If a service is activated for
one or several classes, only the active classes will be displayed (see example 2).
The number of parameters displayed in the ^SCCFC and ^SCLCK output strings differs from the
equivalent +CCFC and +CLCK output strings: In contrast to the +CCFC string, ^SCCFC also includes
the <reason>. Likewise, the ^SCLCK string includes additionally <fac>.
Example 1
When you check the CFU status of all classes, while none is active the following responses will be displayed:
Using at+ccfc=0,2
+CCFC: 0,1
+CCFC: 0,2
+CCFC: 0,4
OK
Using atd*#21#
^SCCFC: 0,0,7
OK
Example 2
To register and activate CFU for voice calls:
at+ccfc=0,3,01771234567
OK
As an alternative you can use the ATD command:
atd**21*01771234567*11#
^SCCFC: 0,1,1,"+491771234567",,145
OK
To check the status of all CFU settings using ATD (only active class will be
displayed):
atd*#21#
^SCCFC: 0,1,1,"+491771234567",145
OK
To check the status of all CFU settings using AT+CCFC (all classes will be
displayed)
at+ccfc=0,2
+CCFC: 1,1,"+491771234567",145
+CCFC: 0,2
+CCFC: 0,4
OK
Example 3
To query the status of CFU for voice calls:
atd*#21**11#;
^SCCFC: 0,1,1,"+491771234567",145
OK
Example 4
To query the status of CFU for voice + SMS + data:
atd*#21**10#;
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 235 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
^SCCFC: 0,1,1,"+493038649027",145
^SCCFC: 0,1,4,"+493038649027",145
OK
The response does not include SMS, since no call forwarding for SMS is not
active.
Example 5
To query the status of CFU for voice + SMS + data:
atd*#21**10#;
^SCCFC: 0,0,7
OK
No CFU enabled for voice + SMS + data.
Example 6
To register and activate CFU for asynchronous data mode (“Data circuit asynchron”):
atd**21*0301234567*25#
^SCCFC: 0,1,2,"+49301234567",145
OK
Example 7
To query the status of CFU for asynchronous data mode:
If CFU is not active the response is not specific to asynchronous data mode.
atd*#21**25#;
^SCCFC: 0,0,7
OK
If CFU is enabled for asynchronous data mode the response is as follows:
atd*#21**25#
^SCCFC: 0,1,2,"+49301234567",145
OK
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 236 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
9.5
Alphabet tables
This section provides tables for the special GSM 03.38 alphabet supported by the ME (see Chapter
“Supported character sets“, pg 12).
Character table of
default GSM 03.38 alphabet
(7 Bits per character):
1)
b4
b3
b2
b1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
b7
b6
b5
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 /A
11 /B
12 /C
13 /D
14 /E
15 /F
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
@
£
$
¥
è
é
ù
ì
ò
Ç
LF
Ø
ø
CR
Å
å
∆
_
Φ
Γ
Λ
Ω
Π
Ψ
Σ
Θ
Ξ
SP
!
„
#
¤
%
&
'
(
)
*
+
,
.
/
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
:
;
<
=
>
?
¡
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
Ä
Ö
Ñ
Ü
§
¿
a
b
c
d
e
f
g
h
i
j
k
l
m
n
o
p
q
r
s
t
u
v
w
x
y
z
ä
ö
ñ
ü
à
1
1
0
6
1
1
1
7
1)
Æ
æ
ß
É
This code is an escape to the following extension of the 7 bit default alphabet table.
Extension table of
GSM 7 bit default alphabet
b4
b3
b2
b1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
b7
b6
b5
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 /A
11 /B
12 /C
13 /D
14 /E
15 /F
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
2
0
1
1
3
1
0
0
4
1
0
1
5
|
^
2)
{
}
3)
1)
[
~
]
\
Page 237 of 238
02.04.2002
AT Command Set
In the event that an MS receives a code where a symbol is not represented in the above table
then the MS shall display the character shown in the main default 7 bit alphabet table.
1) This code value is reserved for the extension to another extension table. On receipt of this
code, a receiving entity shall display a space until another extension table is defined.
2) This code represents the EURO currency symbol. The code value is that used for the character ‘e’. Therefore a receiving entity which is incapable of displaying the EURO currency
symbol will display the character ‘e’ instead.
3) This code is defined as a Page Break character and may be used for example in compressed CBS messages. Any mobile which does not understand the 7 bit default alphabet
table extension mechanism will treat this character as Line Feed.
MC35_ATC_01_V04.00
Page 238 of 238
02.04.2002
Download PDF